Pioneer Home Theater System S DV700ST User Manual

XV-DV900  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wall-mounting the center and  
surround speaker system  
VOLTAGE SELECTOR SWITCH  
Only multi-voltage model is provided with  
this switch.  
Always check that selector are set properly  
before plugging the power cord into the wall  
outlet.  
1. Disconnect the power cord.  
2. Use a small-sized screwdriver.  
3. Insert the screwdriver into the groove on  
the voltage selector, and adjust the  
VOLTAGE SELECTOR.  
Before mounting  
• Remember that the speaker system is heavy  
and that its weight could cause the wood  
screws to work loose, or the wall material to  
fail to support it, resulting in the speaker  
falling. Make sure that the wall you intend to  
mount the speakers on is strong enough to  
support them. Do not mount on plywood or  
soft surface walls.  
• Mounting screws are not supplied. Use  
screws that are suitable for the wall material  
and that will support the weight of the  
speaker.  
VOLTAGE SELECTOR  
240 V  
5 mm  
220V  
–230V  
10 mm  
5 mm  
Wood screw  
110V  
–120V  
Protrusion: 5-7mm  
CAUTION 240 V  
Power source voltage is factory adjusted at  
240 volts. If your area is different, change  
the voltage selector’s setting.  
H039En  
• If you are unsure of the qualities and  
strength of the walls, consult a professional  
for advice.  
• Pioneer is not responsible for any accidents  
or damage that result from improper  
installation.  
On the inside cover of the unit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
These labels can be found on the  
DVD/CD tuner rear panel and bottom  
panel and on the powered subwoofer  
rear panel.  
CAUTION  
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK  
DO NOT OPEN  
[For Taiwanese model]  
Please read through these operating  
instructions so you will know how to  
operate your model properly. After you have  
finished reading the instructions, put them  
away in a safe place for future reference.  
This player is not suitable for commercial  
use.  
Installation precaution  
• Install components so that there are no  
obstructions above or either side, and  
nothing blocking ventilation holes.  
• Leave at least 5 cm of free space around  
the subwoofer and at least 28cm above and  
15cm to the left and right of the DVD/CD  
Tuner, as shown below. Remember to also  
leave 15cm of space at the rear.  
This product incorporates copyright  
protection technology that is protected by  
method claims of certain U.S. patents and  
other intellectual property rights owned by  
Macrovision Corporation and other rights  
owners. Use of this copyright protection  
technology must be authorized by  
Macrovision Corporation, and is intended  
for home and other limited viewing uses  
only unless otherwise authorized by  
Macrovision Corporation. Reverse  
• Use a vacuum cleaner periodically to clean  
the port of the subwoofer to keep it free of  
dust.  
5 cm  
engineering or disassembly is prohibited.  
This product is for general household  
purposes. Any failure due to use for other  
than household purposes (such as long-  
term use for business purposes in a  
restaurant or use in a car or ship) and  
which requires repair will be charged for  
even during the warranty period. K041_En  
Energy-saving design  
This system is designed to use 0.55 W of  
electricity when power is switched to  
standby.  
Powered subwoofer unit (S-DV900/700SW)  
28 cm  
DVD/CD Tuner unit (XV-DV900/700)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Thank you for buying this Pioneer product.  
Please read through these operating instructions so that you will know how to operate your  
model properly. After you have finished reading the instructions, put them in a safe place for  
future reference.  
Contents  
01 Before you start  
04 Home theater sound  
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
Introduction to home theater . . . . . . . . . . . 9  
General disc compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9  
CD-R/RW compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
DVD-R/RW compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
PC-created disc compatibility . . . . . . . . 10  
Compressed audio compatibility . . . . . . 10  
JPEG file compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11  
Auto listening mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30  
Listening in surround sound . . . . . . . . . . .30  
Dolby Pro Logic II Music settings . . . . . .31  
Listening in stereo. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31  
Listening with headphones . . . . . . . . . . . .32  
Using the Advanced Surround effects . . . .32  
Adjusting the Advanced Surround effect  
level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33  
Enhancing dialogue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33  
Listening with a virtual surround back  
speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34  
Using Quiet and Midnight listening  
modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34  
Adjusting the bass and treble . . . . . . . . . .35  
Boosting the bass level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35  
Muting the sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36  
02 Controls and displays  
Front panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
Display unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15  
03 Getting started  
Switching on and setting up. . . . . . . . . . . 18  
Setting the clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19  
Setting up the remote to control your  
05 Playing discs  
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37  
Using the Disc Navigator to browse the  
TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
Using the Room Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
Using the on-screen displays . . . . . . . . . . 21  
Playing discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
Basic playback controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
Resume and Last Memory . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
DVD disc menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Video CD/Super VCD PBC menus . . . . . 26  
Listening to the radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
Improving poor FM reception. . . . . . . . . 28  
Memorizing stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
Listening to station presets . . . . . . . . . . 29  
Listening to other sources . . . . . . . . . . . . 29  
contents of a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37  
Scanning discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38  
Playing in slow motion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39  
Frame advance/frame reverse . . . . . . . . . .39  
Looping a section of a disc . . . . . . . . . . . .40  
Using repeat play. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40  
Using the OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41  
Using the display unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41  
Using random play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42  
Using the OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42  
Creating a program list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43  
Using the OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43  
Using the unit display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46  
Clearing the program list . . . . . . . . . . . .46  
Searching a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46  
Playing DVD-Audio ‘Bonus Groups. . . . . .47  
Switching subtitles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47  
Switching DVD-Video audio language . . . .47  
5
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Switching DVD-Audio audio channels . . . 48  
Switching Video CD/Super VCD audio  
Display settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66  
OSD Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66  
On Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66  
Angle Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67  
Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67  
Parental Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67  
Bonus Group. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69  
Auto Disc Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70  
Group Playback. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70  
DVD Playback Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70  
SACD Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71  
PhotoViewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71  
channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
Zooming the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
Switching camera angles. . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Displaying disc information . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
OSD disc information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Display unit information . . . . . . . . . . . . 51  
06 Viewing JPEG discs  
Playing a JPEG slideshow . . . . . . . . . . . . 52  
Using the JPEG Disc Navigator and Photo  
Browser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52  
Zooming the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53  
11 Other connections  
Connecting external antennas. . . . . . . . . .72  
Connecting auxiliary components . . . . . . .72  
Reducing the TV and line signal levels . .73  
Recording mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74  
Connecting using the S-video output. . . . .74  
Connecting using the component video  
output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75  
07 Using the timer  
Setting the wake-up timer . . . . . . . . . . . . 54  
Turning the wake-up timer on/off . . . . . . 55  
Setting the sleep timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
08 Surround sound setup  
Setting up surround sound . . . . . . . . . . . 57  
System Setup menu options . . . . . . . . . 57  
Setting the channel levels . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
12 Additional information  
Switching off the demo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76  
Child Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76  
Changing the clock format . . . . . . . . . . . .76  
Changing the frequency step. . . . . . . . . . .76  
Setting the TV format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77  
Watching NTSC on a PAL TV  
09 Video Adjust menu  
Video Adjust. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Creating your own presets . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
(MOD. PAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77  
Resetting the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77  
Dimming the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77  
Using and taking care of discs . . . . . . . . .78  
Titles, groups, chapters and tracks . . . . .78  
DVD Video regions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78  
Handling discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79  
Storing discs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79  
Discs to avoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79  
Proper installation and maintenance of this  
system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
Hints on installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
Cleaning the pickup lens. . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
Problems with condensation. . . . . . . . . .80  
Moving the system unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
Power cord caution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81  
10 Initial Settings menu  
Using the Initial Settings menu . . . . . . . . 62  
Digital Audio Mode Settings. . . . . . . . . . . 62  
Dolby Digital Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
DTS Out. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
Linear PCM Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63  
Video Output settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63  
TV Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63  
Component Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64  
S-Video Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65  
Language settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65  
Audio Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65  
Subtitle Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65  
DVD Menu Language. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66  
Subtitle Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66  
6
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
DVD/CD/Video CD player. . . . . . . . . . . . 83  
MP3/JPEG discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84  
Tuner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85  
Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85  
Screen sizes and disc formats . . . . . . . . . 87  
Widescreen TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87  
Standard TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87  
Selecting languages using the language code  
list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87  
Language code list. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88  
Country code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88  
Preset code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89  
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91  
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94  
7
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
01  
Before you start  
CBhaepfteor 1re you start  
Picture zoom  
Features  
While a DVD or Video CD/Super VCD is  
playing, you can zoom in on any part of the  
picture at up to 4x magnification for a closer  
look. See Zooming the screen on page 48.  
DVD-Audio and SACD compatible  
Experience the super high-quality audio  
performance of DVD-Audio and Super Audio  
CD (SACD).  
MP3 compatibility  
The on-board 24-bit/192kHz DAC means that  
this player is fully compatible with high  
sampling-rate discs, capable of delivering  
exceptional sound quality in terms of dynamic  
range, low-level resolution and high-  
frequency detail.  
This system is compatible with CD-R, CD-RW  
and CD-ROM discs that contain MP3 audio  
tracks. See also Compressed audio  
compatibility on page 10.  
Graphical on-screen displays  
Setting up and using your DVD home theater  
system is made very easy using the graphical  
on-screen displays.  
Excellent audio performance with  
Dolby Digital, Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby  
*1  
*2  
Pro Logic II and DTS software  
Energy saving design  
This system is designed to use 0.55 W of  
power when in standby mode.  
Built-in Dolby Digital and DTS decoders let  
you enjoy true discrete multi-channel home  
theater sound with Dolby Digital and DTS  
encoded DVD discs.  
*1 Manufactured under license from Dolby  
Laboratories. “Dolby”, “Pro Logic” and the  
double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby  
Laboratories.  
Dolby Pro Logic and Dolby Pro Logic II  
decoding adds excitement to two-channel  
source material with surround sound  
playback.  
*2 “DTS” and “DTS Digital Surround” are  
registered trademarks of Digital Theater  
Systems, Inc.  
Simple Room Setup for surround sound  
Setting up basic surround sound is made a  
simple two step process with the Room Setup  
feature. Tell the unit the size of your listening  
room and your listening position, and the  
system automatically configures the  
surround sound.  
8
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
Introduction to home theater General disc compatibility  
You are probably used to using stereo  
equipment to listen to music, but may not be  
used to home theater systems that give you  
many more options (such as surround sound)  
when listening to soundtracks.  
This system was designed and engineered to  
be compatible with software bearing one or  
more of the following logos:  
Home theater refers to the use of multiple  
audio tracks to create a surround sound  
effect, making you feel like you're in the  
middle of the action or concert. The surround  
sound you get from a home theater system  
depends not only on the speakers you have  
set up in your room, but also on the source  
and the sound settings of the system.  
DVD-Audio DVD-Video  
DVD-R  
CD-R  
DVD-RW  
CD-RW  
Audio CD  
Video CD  
DVD-Video has become the basic source  
material for home theater due to its size,  
quality, and ease of use. Depending on the  
DVD, you can have up to six different audio  
tracks coming from one disc, all of them  
being sent to different speakers in your  
system. This is what creates a surround  
sound effect and gives you the feeling of  
‘being there’.  
Super Audio CD  
Fujicolor CD  
• KODAK Picture CD  
is a trademark of Fuji Photo Film Co.  
This system will automatically decode Dolby  
Digital, DTS, or Dolby Surround DVD-Video  
discs, according to your speaker setup. In  
most cases, you won’t have to make changes  
for realistic surround sound, but other  
possibilities (like listening to a CD with multi-  
channel surround sound) are explained in  
Home theater sound on page 30.  
Ltd.  
This player supports the IEC’s Super VCD  
standard. Compared to the Video CD  
standard, Super VCD offers superior picture  
quality, and allows two stereo soundtracks to  
be recorded. Super VCD also supports the  
widescreen size.  
VIDEO  
CD  
Super Video CD (Super VCD)  
Other formats, including but not limited to the  
following, are not playable in this system:  
DVD-RAM / DVD-ROM / CD-ROM*  
* Except those that contain MP3 or JPEG.  
See also Compressed audio compatibility  
and JPEG file compatibility below.  
9
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
01  
Before you start  
DVD-R/RW and CD-R/RW discs (Audio CDs  
and Video CDs) recorded using a DVD  
recorder, CD recorder or personal computer  
may not be playable on this system. This may  
be caused by a number of possibilities,  
including but not limited to: the type of disc  
used; the type of recording; damage, dirt or  
condensation on either the disc or the  
player’s pick-up lens. See below for notes  
about particular software and formats.  
PC-created disc compatibility  
• If you record a disc using a personal  
computer, even if it is recorded in a  
“compatible format” as listed above, there  
will be cases in which the disc may not be  
playable in this machine due to the  
setting of the application software used to  
create the disc. In these particular  
instances, check with the software  
publisher for more detailed information.  
• Check the DVD-R/RW or CD-R/RW  
software disc boxes for additional  
compatibility information.  
CD-R/RW compatibility  
• This system will play CD-R and CD-RW  
discs recorded in CD Audio or Video CD  
format, or as a CD-ROM containing MP3  
or JPEG files. However, any other content  
may cause the disc not to play, or create  
noise/distortion in the output.  
Compressed audio compatibility  
• This unit will play CD-ROM, CD-R, and  
CD-RW discs containing files saved in the  
MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3) format with  
a sampling rate of 32, 44.1 or 48kHz.  
Incompatible files will not play and the  
message Can’t play this format will be  
displayed (No Play in the Display unit).  
• This system cannot record CD-R or CD-  
RW discs.  
• Unfinalized CD-R/RW discs recorded as  
CD Audio can be played, but the full Table  
of Contents (playing time, etc.) will not be  
displayed.  
• Fixed bit-rate MP3 files are  
recommended. Variable bit-rate (VBR)  
MP3 files are playable, but playing time  
may not be shown correctly.  
DVD-R/RW compatibility  
• The CD-ROM used to compile your MP3  
files must be ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2  
compliant. CD physical format: Mode1,  
Mode2 XA Form1. Romeo and Joliet file  
systems are both compatible with this  
player.  
• This unit will play DVD-R/RW discs  
recorded using the DVD-Video format that  
have been finalized using a DVD-recorder.  
• This unit will play DVD-RW discs recorded  
using the Video Recording (VR) format.  
DVD-RW shows in the display when a VR  
format DVD-RW disc is loading.  
• Use CD-R or CD-RW media for recording  
your files. The disc must be finalized (i.e.  
the session must be closed) in order to  
play in this unit. This player is not  
compatible with multi-session discs. Only  
the first session of a multi-session disc  
will be recognized.  
• When playing a VR format DVD-RW discs  
that was edited on a DVD recorder, the  
screen may go momentarily black at  
edited points and/or you may see scenes  
from immediately before the edited point.  
• This unit cannot record DVD-R/RW discs.  
• This player only plays tracks that are  
named with the file extension .mp3 or  
.MP3.  
• Unfinalized DVD-R/RW discs cannot be  
played in this player.  
10  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
• When naming MP3 files, add the  
corresponding file name extension  
(.mp3). Files are played according to the  
file extension. To prevent noise and  
malfunctions, do not use these  
extensions for other kinds of files.  
• This player can recognize up to 999 files  
(MP3/JPEG) and up to 499 folders. If a  
disc exceeds these limits, only files and  
folders up to these limits will be playable.  
Files and folders are read/ displayed in  
alphabetical order. Note that if the file  
structure is very complex, you may not be  
able to read/play all files on the disc.  
• Folder and track names (excluding the file  
extension) are displayed.  
• There are many different recording bit-  
rates available to encode MP3 files. This  
unit was designed to be compatible with  
all of them. Audio encoded at 128Kbps  
should sound close to regular CD Audio  
quality. This player will play lower bit-rate  
files, but please note that the sound  
quality becomes noticeably worse at  
lower bit-rates.  
JPEG file compatibility  
• Baseline JPEG and EXIF 2.1* still image  
files up to 8 mega-pixels are supported  
(maximum vertical and horizontal  
resolution is 5120 pixels). (*File format  
used by digital still cameras)  
• The CD-ROM used to compile your JPEG  
files must be ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2  
compliant. CD physical format: Mode1,  
Mode2 XA Form1. Romeo and Joliet file  
systems are both compatible with this  
player.  
• This player only displays files that are  
named with the file extension .jpg or  
.JPG.  
11  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
02  
Controls and displays  
CChaoptnert2rols and displays  
Front panel  
1
2
3
TIMER  
STANDBY/ON  
OPEN/CLOSE  
4
6
7
5
8
1
VOLUME buttons  
5
STANDBY/ON  
Use to adjust the volume.  
Press to switch the system on or into standby.  
2
6
7
Disc tray  
Press to stop playback.  
OPEN/CLOSE  
3
Press to open/close the disc tray.  
Press to switch to the DVD/CD function. Also  
press to start/pause/resume playback.  
8
PHONES jack  
Headphone jack.  
4
Timer indicator  
Lights when the wake-up timer is set (page 54).  
Display unit  
9
10  
9
Remote sensor  
10 Display  
See Display on page 13 for detailed  
information.  
12  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and displays  
02  
Display  
3
5
1
2
4
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13  
14  
MIDNIGHT QUIET  
PGM RPT-1  
RDM  
V.PART  
ATT  
REC MODE  
PRO LOGIC  
DIGITAL  
ADV.SURR.  
PRGSVE  
kHz  
MHz  
20  
19  
18 17 16 15  
1
Tuner indicators  
8
V.PART  
Light when playing a video part of a DVD disc.  
9
ATT  
Lights when a broadcast is being  
received.  
Lights when the input attenuator is active for  
the currently selected analog input (page 73).  
10 REC MODE  
Lights when Rec Mode is active (page 74).  
Lights when a stereo FM broadcast is  
being received in auto stereo mode.  
11 Timer indicators  
Lights when FM mono reception is  
selected.  
Lights when the wake-up timer is set  
(page 54).  
2
Lights when a disc is playing.  
Lights when the sleep timer is active  
(page 56).  
3
MIDNIGHT  
Lights when the Midnight mode is selected  
(page 34).  
12 2 PRO LOGIC II  
Lights during Dolby Pro Logic decoding  
(page 30).  
4
QUIET  
Lights when the Quiet mode is selected  
(page 34).  
13 2DIGITAL  
Lights during playback of a Dolby Digital  
source (page 30).  
5
PGM  
Lights when a program list has been  
programmed (page 43).  
6
RPT and RPT-1  
RPT lights during repeat play. RPT-1 lights  
during repeat one-track play (page 40).  
7
RDM  
Lights during random play (page 42).  
13  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
02  
Controls and displays  
14 Speaker indicators  
These show which speakers are being used to  
output the current source. The illustrations  
below show some example displays.  
5.1 channel surround sound  
Stereo (2.1 channel) sound  
3.1 channel sound with Dialogue  
enhancement on the center  
channel  
5.1 channel surround sound with  
Virtual Surround Back mode active  
15 PRGSVE  
Lights when progressive scan video output is  
selected (page 64).  
16 ADV.SURR.  
Lights when one of the Advanced Surround  
listening modes is selected (page 32).  
17 DTS  
Lights during playback of a DTS source  
(page 30).  
18 kHz / MHz  
Indicates the unit of the frequency shown in  
the character display (kHz for AM, MHz for  
FM).  
19 Character display  
20  
Lights during multi-angle scenes on a DVD  
disc (page 49).  
14  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and displays  
02  
3
DISPLAY  
Remote control  
Press to display/change disc information  
shown on-screen (page 49).  
STANDBY/ON  
1
4
Disc playback controls  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
2
DISPLAY  
OPEN/CLOSE  
Press to start or resume playback.  
3
4
5
6
7
11  
and ꢆ/ꢇ  
Use for reverse slow motion playback,  
frame reverse and reverse scanning.  
12  
13  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
and ꢉ/ꢊ  
Use for forward slow motion playback,  
frame advance and forward scanning.  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
8
9
14  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
Press to pause playback; press again to  
restart.  
TV CONTROL  
10  
15  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
Press to stop playback.  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
5
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
Press to jump to the beginning of the current  
chapter/track, then to previous chapters/  
tracks.  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
SETUP  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
6
DVD MENU  
4
22  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
CLOCK  
Press to display a DVD disc menu, or the Disc  
Navigator if a VR format DVD-RW, CD, Video  
CD/Super VCD, MP3 or JPEG disc is loaded.  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
7
Cursor buttons, ENTER and tuning  
buttons  
Cursor buttons  
Use the cursor buttons (ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ) to  
navigate on-screen displays and menus.  
• Functions printed in green on the remote  
control are accessed by switching the  
MAIN/SUB switch to SUB.  
ENTER  
Press to select an option or execute a  
command.  
1
STANDBY/ON  
Press to switch the system on or into standby.  
TUNE +/–  
Use to tune the radio.  
2
Function select buttons  
Press to select the source you want to listen to  
(DVD (CD). TUNER, TV, LINE)  
ST +/–  
Use to select station presets when  
listening to the radio.  
15  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
02  
Controls and displays  
8
9
MUTE  
(In SUB)  
Press to mute all sound from the speakers  
and headphones (press again to cancel)  
(page 36).  
BASS MODE  
Use to select a Bass Mode (page 35).  
DIALOGUE  
Use to select a Dialogue mode (page 33).  
MASTER VOLUME  
Use to adjust the volume.  
VIRTUAL SB  
Press to switch the Virtual Surround Back  
speaker effect on/off (page 34).  
10 TV CONTROL (page 20)  
Press to switch the TV on or into standby.  
16 DVD/CD buttons  
(In MAIN)  
INPUT  
Press to switch the TV input.  
AUDIO  
CH +/–  
Press to select an audio channel or  
language (page 47).  
Use to select channels on the TV.  
VOL +/–  
SUBTITLE  
Use to adjust the volume on the TV.  
Press to display/change the DVD subtitle  
display (page 47).  
11 OPEN/CLOSE  
Press to open/close the disc tray.  
ANGLE  
Press to change camera angle during  
DVD multi-angle scene playback  
(page 49).  
12 ꢍ  
Press to jump to the next chapter/track.  
13 RETURN  
Press to return to a previous menu screen.  
(In SUB)  
PROGRAM  
Use to program/play a program list  
(page 43).  
14 SOUND  
Press to access the sound menu, from which  
you can adjust the DSP effect level, bass and  
treble, etc.  
REPEAT  
Use to select a repeat play mode  
(page 40).  
15 Surround sound mode/sound  
enhancement buttons  
RANDOM  
Use to select a random play mode  
(page 42).  
(In MAIN)  
AUTO  
Press to select the default decoding for  
the current source (page 30).  
17 (In SUB)  
ZOOM  
SURROUND  
Use to select a Surround mode (page 30).  
Press to change the screen zoom level  
(page 48).  
ADVANCED  
Use to select an Advanced Surround  
(page 32).  
TOP MENU  
Use to display the top menu of a DVD disc  
in the play position (this may be the same  
as pressing DVD MENU).  
16  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and displays  
02  
HOME MENU  
21 MAIN / SUB  
Press to display (or exit) the on-screen  
menu for Initial Settings, Play Mode  
functions, etc.  
Change from MAIN to SUB to access  
functions printed in green.  
(In MAIN)  
18 (In SUB)  
ROOM SETUP  
SYSTEM SETUP  
Press to start Room Setup (page 20).  
Use to make various system and surround  
sound settings (page 57).  
22 (In MAIN)  
Number buttons  
Use the number buttons for selecting  
titles/chapters/tracks from a disc directly.  
TEST TONE  
Use to output the test tone (for speaker  
setup) (page 59).  
CH LEVEL  
Use to adjust the speaker level (page 59).  
19 (In SUB)  
DIMMER  
Press to dim or brighten the display.  
QUIET/MIDNIGHT  
Use to select the Quiet and Midnight  
modes (page 34).  
TIMER/CLOCK  
Press to display the clock and to access  
the timer menu (page 19 and page 54).  
20 (In MAIN)  
CLR  
Press to clear an entry.  
ENTER  
Selects menu options, etc. (works exactly  
the same as the ENTER button in 7  
above).  
(In SUB)  
FOLDER –  
Press to jump to previous folders.  
FOLDER +  
Press to jump to the next folder.  
17  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
Getting started  
Chapter 3  
Getting started  
You should see the welcome screen  
displayed.  
Switching on and setting up  
After making sure everything is connected up  
properly, you’re ready to switch on. The first  
thing to do is to tell the system what kind of TV  
you’re using, standard or widescreen.  
Welcome to Pioneer DVD!  
Thank you for purchasing this Pioneer DVD player.  
After that you can set up the surround sound  
for your room, and set the clock so that you  
can use the timer features.  
Before using, please take a little time  
to setup your DVD player  
Put the batteries into the remote control  
Next, press the [ENTER] button on the remote control  
and start the Let's Get Started Menu  
Next  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
2
Press ENTER to move on to the next  
screen.  
3
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select either ‘Wide screen  
(16:9)’ or ‘Standard size screen (4:3)’  
according to the kind of TV you have, then  
press ENTER.  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
See also Screen sizes and disc formats on  
page 87 if you’re not sure which one to  
choose.  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
Let's Get Started Menu  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
What kind of TV do you have?  
Use the  
/
cursor buttons  
1
Press STANDBY/ON (on the remote  
to choose, then press [ENTER]  
or on the front panel) to switch the  
system on.  
Also make sure that your TV is switched on  
and that the video input is set to this system.  
Wide screen (16:9)  
Standard size screen (4:3)  
18  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
03  
4
Press ENTER again to finish setting up.  
Setting the clock  
Setting the clock allows you to use the timer  
features.  
Let's Get Started Menu  
Setup complete  
STANDBY/ON  
If you're finished setting up,  
choose [Complete],  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
to start again choose [Back]  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
Complete  
Back  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
• Use the (cursor right) button to select  
Back then press ENTER if you want to go  
back and change the setting you just  
made.  
ENTER  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
• You can also use the function buttons  
(DVD/CD, TUNER, etc.) or the OPEN/  
CLOSE button to switch the system on  
from standby.  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
1
2
Press TIMER/CLOCK.  
• If you are adjusting the clock, rather then  
setting it for the first time, press TIMER/  
CLOCK again.  
If ‘Clock ADJ?’ isn’t already showing in  
the display, press or (cursor left or  
right) until you see it.  
3
4
Press ENTER.  
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to set the hour.  
5
Press ENTER.  
19  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
Getting started  
6
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
buttons to set the minute.  
TV CONTROL  
7
Press ENTER to confirm.  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
The display flashes to indicate the clock is set.  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
AUTO  
VIRTUAL SB  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
• Press TIMER/CLOCK anytime to display  
the clock.  
Button  
What it does  
Switches your TV on or into  
standby.  
CH +/–  
VOL +/–  
INPUT  
Changes the TV channel.  
Adjusts the TV volume.  
• If you unplug the system from the wall  
outlet, or there is a power outage, you will  
need to set the clock again.  
Switches the TV’s input  
between the built in TV tuner  
and an external video source.  
Setting up the remote to control  
your TV  
You can set up the supplied remote to control  
your TV using the TV CONTROL buttons.  
• The default setting is for a Pioneer TV.  
1
Switch on your TV.  
2
Find the name of the manufacturer of  
Using the Room Setup  
your TV in the Preset code list on page 89  
Next to each manufacturer is one or more  
three digit codes. These tell the remote what  
kind of TV you have.  
Before using your system to enjoy surround  
sound playback, we recommend you spend a  
few minutes using the Room Setup. This is a  
quick and easy way to get good surround  
sound for your room.  
If the name of the manufacturer of your TV  
does not appear in the table, you won’t be  
able to set up this remote to control your TV.  
Depending on the distance of the surround  
speakers from your main listening position,  
choose between S (small), M (medium), or L  
(large) room, then depending on your seating  
position relative to the front and surround  
speakers, choose Fwd (forward), Mid  
(middle), or Back.  
3
Point the remote at your TV, hold  
down the CLR button, then enter the  
three digit code for your TV.  
The remote transmits an on/off signal to the  
TV. If you’ve entered the correct code, your TV  
should switch off.  
If your TV doesn’t turn off, repeat the  
procedure using the next code in the list until  
your TV switches off successfully. Once set,  
you can then use the individual TV controls  
shown below.  
20  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
03  
1
If the system isn’t already on, press  
• For a more detailed surround sound  
setup, see Setting up surround sound on  
page 57.  
STANDBY/ON to switch it on.  
2
Press ROOM SETUP.  
• If you have previously set up the room type  
and seating position, the display will show  
the current room settings.  
Using the on-screen displays  
For ease of use, this system makes extensive  
use of graphical on-screen displays (OSDs).  
You should get used to the way these work as  
you’ll need to use them when setting up the  
system, using some of the playback features,  
such as program play, and when making  
more advanced settings for audio and video.  
3
4
Press ENTER.  
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to select a room type then press  
ENTER.  
Choose one of the following depending on  
your room size:  
All the screens are navigated in basically the  
same way, using the cursor buttons (, ,  
, ) to change the highlighted item and  
pressing ENTER to select it.  
S – Smaller than average room  
M – Average room  
L – Larger than average room  
5
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to select a seating position  
setting, then press ENTER.  
Choose one of the following depending on  
where your main listening position is:  
• Throughout this manual, ‘Select’ means  
use the cursor buttons to highlight an  
item on-screen, then press ENTER.  
Fwd – If you are nearer to the front  
speakers than the surround speakers  
Mid – If you are equal distance from the  
front and surround speakers  
Back – If you are nearer to the surround  
speakers than the front speakers  
• The Room Setup automatically sets up  
both channel level and speaker distance.  
If you have already set the channel levels  
manually (see page 59) or speaker  
distance settings (see page 58), you will  
see Room Set? in the display when you  
first press the ROOM SETUP button.  
• Using the Room Setup will overwrite any  
previous settings you had for channel  
level and speaker distance.  
21  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
Getting started  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
• The button guide at the bottom of every  
OSD screen shows you which buttons  
you’ll need to use for that screen.  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
ENTER  
Playing discs  
MUTE  
SOUND  
The basic playback controls for playing DVD,  
CD, SACD, Video CD/Super VCD and MP3  
discs are covered here. Further functions are  
detailed in the chapter 5.  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
Throughout this manual, the term ‘DVD’  
means any kind of DVD disc (DVD-Video,  
DVD-Audio or DVD-R/RW).  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
1
If the player isn’t already on, press  
STANDBY/ON to switch it on.  
If you’re playing a DVD or Video CD/Super  
VCD also turn on your TV and make sure that  
it is set to the correct video input.  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
2
Press OPEN/CLOSE to open the disc  
tray.  
Button  
What it does  
3
Load a disc.  
Displays/exits the on-screen  
display  
HOME  
MENU  
Load a disc with the label side facing up,  
using the disc tray guide to align the disc (if  
you’re loading a double-sided DVD disc, load  
it with the side you want to play face down).  
ꢂꢀꢁꢃ  
Changes the highlighted menu  
item  
Selects the highlighted menu  
item (both ENTER buttons work  
in exactly the same way)  
ENTER  
Returns to the main menu  
without saving changes  
RETURN  
22  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
03  
4
Press (play) to start playback.  
Basic playback controls  
If you’re playing a DVD or Video CD/Super  
VCD, a menu may appear. See DVD disc  
menus on page 25 and Video CD/Super VCD  
PBC menus on page 26 for how to navigate  
these.  
The table below shows the basic controls on  
the remote for playing discs. You can find  
other playback features in the chapter 5.  
STANDBY/ON  
If you’re playing an MP3 disc, it may take a  
few seconds before playback starts,  
depending on the complexity of the file  
structure on the disc.  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
If you loaded a CD/CD-R/RW containing  
JPEGs, a slideshow will start. See Viewing  
JPEG discs on page 52 for more on playing  
these discs.  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
• See also PhotoViewer on page 71 if the  
disc contains both MP3 audio files and  
JPEG picture files.  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
5
Use the MASTER VOLUME – / + button  
TV CONTROL  
(or the top panel VOLUME buttons) to  
adjust the volume.  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
Button  
What it does  
Starts playback.  
DVD and Video CD: If the display  
shows Resume or Last Mem  
playback starts from the resume  
or last memory point (see also  
Resume and Last Memory  
below.)  
23  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
Getting started  
Button  
What it does  
Pauses a disc that’s playing, or  
restarts a paused disc.  
• You may find with some DVD discs that  
some playback controls don’t work in  
certain parts of the disc. This is not a  
malfunction.  
Stops playback.  
DVD and Video CD: The display  
shows Resume. Press again if  
you want to cancel the resume  
function. (See also Resume and  
Last Memory below.)  
• Track skip and number buttons for track  
selection do not work with unfinalized CD-  
R/RW discs.  
Using the top panel controls  
Press to start fast reverse  
scanning. Press (play) to  
resume normal playback.  
The OPEN/CLOSE, and (stop)  
buttons on the top panel work the same way  
as the remote control equivalents.  
Press to start fast forward  
scanning. Press (play) to  
resume normal playback.  
Resume and Last Memory  
When you stop playback of a DVD or Video CD  
disc, Resume is shown in the display indi-  
cating that you can resume playback again  
from that point.  
Skips to the start of the current  
track or chapter, then to previous  
tracks/chapters.  
If the disc tray is not opened, the next time you  
start playback the display shows Resume and  
playback resumes from the resume point.  
Skips to the next track or chapter.  
FOLDER+/– Skips to the next/previous folder  
For DVD discs only: If you take the disc out of  
the player, the play position is stored in  
memory. When you load the disc next time,  
the display shows Last Mem and you can  
resume playback (this works for up to five  
discs).  
(SUB)  
when playing a JPEG or MP3  
disc.  
Numbers  
Use to enter a title/track/group/  
chapter number. Press ENTER to  
select (or wait a few seconds).  
• If the disc is stopped, playback  
starts from the selected title/  
group (for DVD-Video/DVD-  
Audio) or track number (for  
SACD/CD/Video CD/Super VCD/  
MP3).  
If you want to clear the resume/last memory  
point, press (stop) while Resume or Last  
Mem is displayed.  
• If the disc is playing, playback  
jumps to the start of the selected  
chapter or track (within the  
current group for DVD-Audio).  
• When a Video CD is loaded, the Resume  
point is lost if the system is switched off,  
or switched to a function other than DVD  
(CD).  
• For the Last Memory function to work, you  
must press (stop) to stop playback  
before opening the disc tray.  
24  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
03  
• Resume and Last Memory are not avail-  
able with DVD-Audio discs.  
Some movie formats are such that even  
when played on a widescreen TV, black  
bars are necessary at the top and bottom  
of the screen. This is not a malfunction.  
• The Last Memory function doesn’t work  
with VR format DVD-RW discs.  
• I have a standard (4:3) TV and set the  
system to show widescreen DVDs in pan &  
scan format, so why do I still get black bars  
top and bottom with some discs?  
• With MP3 format discs, playback does not  
resume. Instead, playback begins of the  
first track of the folder containing the file  
that was playing when playback was  
stopped.  
Some discs override the display  
preferences of the system, so even if you  
have 4:3 (Pan & Scan) selected, those  
discs will still be shown in letterbox  
format. This is not a malfunction.  
• After I load a DVD disc, it ejects  
automatically after a few seconds!  
• Why can’t I hear DVD-Audio and SACD  
audio through the digital outputs?  
Most likely, the disc is the wrong region  
for your system. The region number  
should be printed on the disc; check it  
against the region number of the system  
(which you can find on the rear panel).  
See also DVD Video regions on page 78.  
DVD-Audio and SACD audio is only  
available through the analog outputs. This  
is not a malfunction.  
• My DVD-Audio disc starts playing, but then  
suddenly stops!  
If the region number is OK, it may be that  
the disc is damaged or dirty. Clean the  
disc and look for signs of damage. See  
also Using and taking care of discs on  
page 78.  
The disc may have been illegally copied.  
DVD disc menus  
Many DVD-Video and DVD-Audio discs  
contain menus from which you can select  
what you want to watch or listen to. They may  
give access to additional features, such as  
subtitle and audio language selection, or  
special features such as slideshows. See the  
disc packaging for details.  
• Why won’t the disc I loaded play?  
First check that you loaded the disc the  
right way up (label side up), and that it’s  
clean and not damaged. See Using and  
taking care of discs on page 78 for  
information on cleaning discs.  
Sometimes DVD menus are displayed  
automatically when you start playback; others  
only appear when you press DVD MENU or  
TOP MENU.  
If a disc loaded correctly won’t play, it’s  
probably an incompatible format or disc  
type, such as DVD-ROM. See General disc  
compatibility on page 9 for more on disc  
compatibility.  
• I have a widescreen TV so why are there  
black bars at the top and bottom of the  
screen when I play some discs?  
• Some DVD-Audio discs feature a bonus  
group. To access this group you have to  
input a password which you can find on  
the disc packaging. See page 69 for more  
information.  
25  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
Getting started  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
SOUND  
Video CD/Super VCD PBC menus  
Some Video CD/Super VCDs have menus  
from which you can choose what you want to  
watch. These are called PBC (Playback  
control) menus.  
ENTER  
MUTE  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
You can play a PBC Video CD/Super VCD  
without having to navigate the PBC menu by  
pressing (stop) then starting playback  
using a number button to select a track,  
rather than (play) (or on the top panel).  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
TUNE+  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
ST–  
ST+  
8
9
ENTER  
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
CLR  
MUTE  
SOUND  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
Button  
What it does  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
Displays the ‘top menu’ of a DVD  
disc—this varies with the disc.  
TOP MENU  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
Displays a DVD disc menu—this  
varies with the disc and may be  
the same as the ‘top menu’.  
DVD  
MENU  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
ꢂꢀꢁꢃ  
Moves the cursor around the  
screen.  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
Selects the current menu option.  
MAIN  
SUB  
ENTER  
Returns to the previously  
RETURN  
displayed menu screen. On  
some DVD-Audio discs featuring  
browsable pictures, press to  
display the browser screen.  
Numbers  
(MAIN)  
Highlights a numbered menu  
option (some discs only). Press  
ENTER to select (or wait a few  
seconds).  
26  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
03  
Listening to the radio  
Button  
What it does  
The tuner can receive both FM and AM  
broadcasts, and lets you memorize your  
favorite stations so you don’t have to manually  
tune in every time you want to listen.  
Displays the PBC menu.  
RETURN  
Numbers  
Selects a numbered menu  
option.  
Displays the previous menu page  
(if there is one).  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
Displays the next menu page (if  
there is one).  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
Press to select highlighted menu  
option.  
ENTER  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
1
If the system isn’t already on, press  
STANDBY/ON to switch on.  
2
Press TUNER to switch to the tuner,  
then press repeatedly to select the AM or  
FM band.  
The display indicates the tuner band and the  
frequency.  
3
Tune to a frequency.  
There are three tuning modes—manual, auto,  
and high-speed:  
27  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
Getting started  
Manual tuning: Press TUNE +/–  
repeatedly to change the displayed  
frequency.  
Memorizing stations  
You can save up to 30 station presets so that  
you always have easy access to your favorite  
stations without having to tune in manually  
each time.  
Auto tuning: Press and hold TUNE +/–  
until the frequency display starts to move,  
then release. The tuner will stop on the  
next station it finds. Repeat to search for  
other stations.  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
High-speed tuning: Press and hold  
TUNE +/– until the frequency display  
starts to move rapidly. Keep the button  
held down until you reach the frequency  
you want. If necessary, fine tune the  
frequency using the manual tuning  
method.  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
Improving poor FM reception  
If you’re listening to an FM station in stereo  
but the reception is weak, you can improve  
the sound quality by switching to mono.  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
1
2
3
Tune to an FM radio station.  
Press SYSTEM SETUP.  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
SUBTITLE  
buttons to choose ‘FM Mode?’ then press  
ENTER.  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
buttons to select ‘FM Mono’ then press  
ENTER.  
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
The mono indicator ( ) lights when the tuner  
is in mono reception mode.  
Select FM Auto above to switch back to auto-  
1
Tune to an AM or FM radio station.  
For the FM band, select mono or auto-stereo  
reception as necessary. This setting is saved  
along with the preset.  
stereo mode (the stereo indicator ( ) lights  
when receiving a stereo broadcast).  
28  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
03  
2
3
Press SYSTEM SETUP.  
Listening to other sources  
You can connect up to four external sources  
(TV, satellite receiver, etc.) to this system,  
including one digital source. See also  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to choose ‘St. Memory?’ then  
press ENTER.  
Connecting auxiliary components on page 72.  
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to select the station preset you  
want.  
There are 30 preset locations; each can store  
one station preset.  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
5
Press ENTER to save the station preset.  
• If the system is unplugged from the power  
supply completely, saved stations will  
remain for several days, after which you’ll  
have to save them again.  
1
If the system isn’t already on, press ꢂ  
STANDBY/ON to switch on.  
Also make sure that the external source (TV,  
satellite receiver, etc.) is switched on.  
2
Select the source you want to listen to.  
• Press TV to select the TV input, or use the  
LINE (L1/L2) button to select the LINE 1  
ANA, LINE1 DIG or LINE 2 ANA input.  
Listening to station presets  
Make sure the TUNER function is  
1
selected.  
3
If necessary, start playback of the  
2
Use the ST +/– buttons to select a  
external source.  
station preset.  
29  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
Home theater sound  
Chapter 4  
Home theater sound  
Using this system you can enjoy listening to  
sources, analog or digital, in either stereo or  
surround sound.  
Listening in surround sound  
You can listen to any source—stereo or  
multichannel, analog or digital—in surround  
sound. Surround sound is generated from  
stereo sources (except SACD and DVD-Audio)  
using one of the Dolby Pro Logic decoding  
modes.  
Auto listening mode  
The Auto listening mode is the simplest way  
to listen to any source as it was mastered: the  
output from the speakers mirrors the  
channels in the source material.  
BASS MODE 
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
TOP MENU  
2
ZOOM  
1
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SETUP  
SUBTITLE  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
HOME  
MENU  
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
8
9
3
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
CLR  
4
ROOM SETUP  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
MAIN  
SUB  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
Press SURROUND repeatedly to select  
a listening mode (or press SURROUND  
then use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons).  
The listening mode choices that appear in the  
display will vary according to the type of  
source that’s playing.  
Press AUTO to select the ‘Auto’  
listening mode.  
If the source is Dolby Digital or DTS, the  
2DIGITAL or DTS indicator on the display  
unit lights.  
Auto – Auto listening mode (see above)  
Dolby Digital / DTS – Dolby Digital or  
DTS decoding (depending on the source).  
For a multichannel source, this will be the  
same as Auto.  
• Any previously active Dolby Pro Logic or  
Advanced Surround mode is canceled  
when Auto listening mode is selected.  
Pro Logic – 4.1 channel surround sound  
for use with any two-channel source  
PL II Movie – Pro Logic II 5.1 channel  
surround sound, especially suited to  
movie sources, for use with any two-  
channel source  
30  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Home theater sound  
04  
PL II Music – Pro Logic II 5.1 channel  
surround sound, especially suited to  
music sources, for use with any two-  
channel source (see also Dolby Pro Logic  
II Music settings below)  
1
With Dolby Pro Logic II Music mode  
active, press SOUND.  
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘C Width’, ‘Dimen.’ or  
‘Pnrm.’  
Stereo – See Listening in stereo below  
C Width (Center Width): Makes the  
center channel wider (higher settings) or  
narrower (lower settings)  
Dimen. (Dimension): Makes the sound  
more distant (minus settings), or more  
forward (positive settings)  
• See also Using the Advanced Surround  
effects on page 32, for further stereo and  
surround playback options.  
Pnrm. (Panorama): Creates more  
spacious surround sound  
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to adjust the setting.  
Center Width is adjustable between 0 and 7;  
Dimension between –3 and +3. Panorama is  
On or Off.  
• You can’t use the Surround modes with  
SACD, DVD-Audio and 96 kHz PCM  
sources.  
• When headphones are connected, only  
the Stereo option is available.  
4
Press ENTER to confirm.  
• When listening in Dolby Digital / DTS  
mode, two-channel material will  
automatically be played in surround  
sound using Dolby Pro Logic decoding.  
Listening in stereo  
You can listen to any source—stereo or  
multichannel, analog or digital—in stereo.  
When playing a multichannel source, stereo  
sound is created by downmixing all channels  
to the front left/right speakers and the  
subwooofer.  
• Dolby Digital / DTS sources that use only  
the center channel cannot be played back  
in surround sound.  
Dolby Pro Logic II Music settings  
When listening in Dolby Pro Logic II Music  
mode, there are three further parameters you  
can adjust: Center Width, Dimension, and  
Panorama.  
BASS MODE 
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
Default Settings:  
C Width: 3  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
Dimen.: 0  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
Pnrm.: Off  
Press SURROUND repeatedly until  
‘Stereo’ shows in the display.  
Any active Advanced Surround mode is  
canceled.  
31  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
Home theater sound  
Using the Advanced Surround  
effects  
• See also Using the Advanced Surround  
effects below, for further stereo and  
surround playback options.  
Advanced Surround effects can be used with  
multichannel or stereo sources for a variety of  
additional surround sound effects.  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
Listening with headphones  
When headphones are connected, only the  
Stereo (default) and Phones Surround  
(virtual surround sound for headphones)  
modes are available.  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
With headphones connected, press  
ENTER  
ADVANCED to select ‘Phones Surround’ or  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
SURROUND to select ‘Stereo’.  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
Press ADVANCED to select an  
Advanced Surround mode (or press  
ADVANCED then use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/  
down) bottons).  
Press repeatedly to select from:  
Adv. Music – Gives a concert hall-type  
sound  
Adv. Movie – Gives a movie theater-type  
sound  
Expanded – Creates an extra wide stereo  
field  
TV Surr. – Designed for mono or stereo TV  
broadcasts and other sources  
32  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Home theater sound  
04  
Sports – Designed for sports and other  
programs based on commentary  
Enhancing dialogue  
• Default setting: Dialog Off  
Game – Creates surround sound from  
video game sources  
The Dialogue Enhancement feature is  
designed to make the dialog stand out from  
other background sounds in a TV or movie  
soundtrack.  
ExPwrSurr. (Extra Power Surround) –  
Gives additional energy and width to  
stereo sources  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
ADVANCED  
Virtual – Creates the impression of  
surround sound from just the front  
speakers  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
5ch Stereo – Designed to give powerful  
surround sound to stereo music sources  
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
• You can’t use the Advanced Surround  
modes with SACD, DVD-Audio and 96 kHz  
PCM sources.  
Press DIALOGUE to select the amount  
dialog enhancement.  
Press repeatedly to select from:  
• You can use any of the above Advanced  
Surround modes with any type of source.  
The descriptions are given only as a guide.  
Dialog Off – No dialog enhancement  
Dialog Mid – Moderate dialog  
enhancement  
• When headphones are connected, only  
the Phones Surround option is available.  
Dialog Max – Strong dialog  
enhancement  
Adjusting the Advanced Surround  
effect level  
You can emphasize or reduce the effect of the  
Advanced Surround modes as you like. For  
each Advanced Surround mode you can set  
the effect level independently.  
• You can’t use Dialog Enhancement with  
SACD, DVD-Audio and 96 kHz PCM  
sources.  
1
With one of the Advanced Surround  
modes active, press SOUND.  
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘Effect’.  
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to adjust the effect level.  
The effect level can be adjusted from 10 (min)  
to 90 (max).  
4
Press ENTER to confirm.  
33  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
Home theater sound  
Listening with a virtual  
Using Quiet and Midnight  
surround back speaker  
listening modes  
• Default setting: Vir. SB Off  
• Default setting: Off  
The Virtual Surround Back feature can be  
used when listening in surround sound to  
simulate an added surround back channel. In  
a real theater the surround back speaker  
would be directly behind you, creating more  
cohesive and realistic surround sound.  
The Quiet listening feature reduces excessive  
bass or treble in a sound source. You can use  
this feature if the music is a little bit harsh and  
you would like a smoother sound.  
The Midnight listening feature allows you to  
hear effective surround sound of movies at  
low volume levels. The effect automatically  
adjusts according to the volume at which  
you’re listening.  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
3
CLR  
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
Press VIRTUAL SB repeatedly to switch  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
between ‘Vir. SB On’ and ‘Vir. SB Off’.  
Press QUIET/MIDNIGHT repeatedly to  
switch between ‘Quiet’, ‘Midnight’ and  
‘Off’.  
• You can’t use Virtual Surround Back  
when listening in Stereo or Virtual  
listening modes.  
• You can’t use Virtual Surround Back  
when headphones are connected.  
When the headphones are connected, you  
can't set Quiet/Midnight in the following  
cases:  
• If there is no surround channel, Virtual  
Surround Back has no effect.  
• When an SACD or DVD-Audio disc is  
loaded.  
• You can’t use the Virtual Surround  
Back effect with SACD, DVD-Audio and  
96 kHz PCM sources.  
34  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Home theater sound  
04  
Adjusting the bass and treble Boosting the bass level  
• Default setting: Treble: 0, Bass: 0  
There are three bass modes you can use to  
enhance the bass in a source.  
Use the bass and treble controls to adjust the  
overall tone. Bass and treble adjustment is  
not possible when the Quiet or Midnight  
modes are active.  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
Press BASS MODE repeatedly to  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
choose an option that fits the source  
you’re listening to.  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
Music – Can be used with music to give a  
deeper bass sound  
1
2
Press SOUND.  
Cinema – Good for action movies or  
movies with lots of sound effects  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘Bass’ or ‘Treble’.  
P. Bass – Can be used with music sources  
to bring the beat of the music (or  
soundtrack) to the forefront  
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to adjust the sound.  
The bass and treble can be adjusted from –3  
to +3.  
• Off  
4
Press ENTER to confirm.  
• You can’t use the bass mode with SACD  
and DVD-Audio sources.  
• You can't use the bass mode when the  
headphones are connected.  
When the headphones are connected, you  
can't adjust treble/bass in the following  
cases:  
• When Recording Mode is ON  
• When an SACD or DVD-Audio disc is  
loaded.  
35  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
Home theater sound  
Muting the sound  
Use the MUTE button if you need to  
momentarily turn off all sound from the  
speakers.  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
Press MUTE to mute the volume.  
To cancel, adjust the volume or press MUTE  
again.  
36  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing discs  
05  
CPhlaapteyr i5ng discs  
1
Press HOME MENU and select ‘Disc  
Introduction  
Navigator’ from the on-screen display.  
Alternatively, if a VR format DVD-RW, CD,  
Video CD/Super VCD or MP3/JPEG disc is  
loaded, you can press DVD MENU, which  
takes you straight to the Disc Navigator  
screen.  
Most of the features described in this chapter  
make use of on-screen displays. For an expla-  
nation of how to navigate these, see Using the  
on-screen displays on page 21.  
Many of the functions covered in this chapter  
apply to DVD and SACD discs, Video CD/  
Super VCDs, CDs and MP3/JPEG discs,  
although the exact operation of some varies  
slightly with the kind of disc loaded.  
HOME MENU  
DVD  
Play Mode  
Video Adjust  
Some DVD discs restrict the use of some  
functions (random or repeat, for example).  
This is not a malfunction.  
Disc Navigator  
Initial Settings  
When playing Video CD/Super VCDs, some of  
the functions are not available during PBC  
playback. If you want to use them, start the  
disc playing using a number button to select  
a track.  
2
Select what you want to play.  
Depending on the type of disc you have loaded,  
the Disc Navigator looks slightly different.  
The screen for DVD-Video discs shows the  
titles on the left and the chapters on the right.  
Select a title, or a chapter within a title.  
• To access functions printed in green on  
the remote, move the slider switch from  
MAIN to SUB.  
Disc Navigator  
Title 1-10  
Chapter 1-3  
DVD  
Title 01  
Title 02  
Title 03  
Title 04  
Title 05  
Title 06  
Title 07  
Title 08  
Chapter 001  
Chapter 002  
Chapter 003  
Using the Disc Navigator to  
browse the contents of a disc  
Use the Disc Navigator to browse through the  
contents of a disc to find the part you want to  
play. You can use the Disc Navigator when a  
disc is playing or stopped.  
For DVD-Audio, select a group or a track  
within a group.  
Disc Navigator  
Group 1-3  
Track 1-36  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
Track 05  
Track 06  
Track 07  
Track 08  
Group 01  
Group 02  
Group 03  
DVD-Audio  
37  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
Playing discs  
For SACD, select a track within the current  
playback area.  
The screen for an MP3 disc shows the folder  
names on the left and the track names on the  
right (note that if there are more than 16  
folders or names that contain accented or  
non-roman characters, tracks and folders  
may show up with generic names – F_033,  
T_035, etc.).  
Disc Navigator  
Track 1-14  
2ch Area  
Track 001  
Track 002  
Track 003  
Track 004  
Track 005  
Track 006  
Track 007  
Track 008  
Select a folder, or a track within a folder.  
Disc Navigator  
Folder 1-17  
Track 1-10  
For a VR (Video Recording) mode DVD-RW  
disc select beween the Playlist and Original  
areas of the disc, or a title. Press (cursor  
right) to preview the title.  
MP3  
001. ACP  
002. Nth Degree  
003. Pfeuti  
001. Gravity deluxe  
002.Tesla's patent  
003. Border dispute  
004. Delayed by rain  
005. Accident incident  
006. Pigeon post  
004. Live  
005. Glitch music  
006. CodHead  
007.Thermo  
008. Missing Man  
007. Outernational  
008. Vacuum tube  
• It’s not possible to switch between Orig-  
inal and Playlist during playback.  
Playback starts after you press ENTER.  
• Not all VR format DVD-RW discs have a  
Playlist.  
Disc Navigator  
Title(1-3)  
DVD-RW  
Original  
01. 3/31 FIRST LEAGUE  
02. 4/28 SECOND LEAGUE  
03. 4/29 FINAL ROUND  
• The Disc Navigator is not available unless  
there is a disc loaded.  
Play List  
• It’s not possible to use the Disc Navigator  
when playing a Video CD/Super VCD in  
PBC mode, or an unfinalized CD-R/RW  
disc.  
The screen for CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs  
shows a list of tracks. (The screen below  
shows a CD loaded.)  
• Another way to find a particular place on  
a disc is to use one of the search modes.  
See Searching a disc on page 46.  
Disc Navigator  
Track 1-10  
Scanning discs  
CD  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
Track 05  
Track 06  
Track 07  
Track 08  
You can fast-scan discs forward or backward  
at various different speeds.  
1
During playback, press or to  
start scanning.  
2
Press repeatedly to increase the scan-  
ning speed.  
• MP3 tracks can only be scanned at one  
speed.  
• The scanning speed is shown on-screen.  
38  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing discs  
05  
3
To resume normal playback, press ꢄ  
4
To resume normal playback, press ꢄ  
(play).  
(play).  
• Sound can be heard while scanning audio  
CDs, SACD and MP3 discs.  
• Video CD/Super VCD only supports  
forward slow motion playback.  
• When scanning a Video CD/Super VCD or  
MP3 track, playback automatically  
resumes at the end or beginning of the  
track.  
• The picture quality during slow motion  
playback is not as good as during normal  
playback.  
• Depending on the disc, normal playback  
may automatically resume when a new  
chapter is reached.  
• There is no sound while scanning DVD-  
Videos and Video CD/Super VCDs, and no  
subtitles while scanning DVD-Videos.  
• Depending on the disc, normal playback  
may automatically resume when a new  
chapter is reached on a DVD-Video disc.  
Frame advance/frame reverse  
You can advance or back up DVD-Video or VR  
format DVD-RW discs frame-by-frame. With  
Video CD/Super VCDs, you can only use  
frame advance.  
Playing in slow motion  
You can play DVD-Video, DVD-R/RW and  
Video CD/Super VCDs at four different  
forward slow motion speeds. DVD-Videos and  
DVD-R/RW discs can also be played at two  
reverse speeds.  
1
During playback, press (pause)  
(on the top panel).  
2
Press ꢆ/ꢇ or ꢉ/ꢊ to reverse or  
advance a frame at a time.  
3
To resume normal playback, press ꢄ  
1
During playback, press (pause)  
(play) (on the top panel).  
(on the top panel).  
2
Press and hold ꢆ/ꢇ or ꢉ/ꢊ until  
slow motion playback starts.  
• The slow motion speed is shown on-  
screen.  
• The picture quality when using frame  
reverse is not as good as frame advance.  
• There is no sound during slow motion  
playback.  
• Depending on the disc, normal playback  
may automatically resume when a new  
chapter is reached.  
3
Press repeatedly to change the slow  
motion speed.  
• The slow motion speed is displayed on-  
screen.  
• When changing direction with a DVD  
disc, the picture may ‘move’ in an unex-  
pected way. This is not a malfunction.  
39  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
Playing discs  
4
Press ENTER on ‘B(End Point)’ to set  
Looping a section of a disc  
the loop end point.  
The A-B Repeat function allows you to specify  
two points (A and B) within a track (CD and  
Video CD) or title (DVD-Video and DVD-RW)  
that form a loop which is played over and over.  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
A(Start Point)  
B(End Point)  
Off  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
• You can’t use A-B Repeat with MP3 discs,  
DVD-Audio, SACD, Super VCD discs,  
Video CDs in PBC mode or unfinalized  
CD-R/RW discs.  
After pressing ENTER, playback jumps back  
to the start point and plays the loop.  
• The minimum loop time is 2 seconds.  
1
During playback, press HOME MENU  
and select ‘Play Mode’.  
5
To resume normal playback, select  
‘Off’ from the menu.  
2
Select ‘A-B Repeat’ from the list of  
functions on the left.  
Using repeat play  
Play Mode  
There are various repeat play options,  
depending on the kind of disc loaded. It’s also  
possible to use repeat play together with  
program play to repeat the tracks/chapters in  
the program list (see Creating a program list  
on page 43).  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
A(Start Point)  
B(End Point)  
Off  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
3
Press ENTER on ‘A(Start Point)’ to set  
the loop start point.  
• You can’t use Repeat play with Video CD/  
Super VCDs in PBC mode, or unfinalized  
CD-R/RW discs.  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
A(Start Point)  
B(End Point)  
Off  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
40  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing discs  
05  
For SACDs, CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs,  
select Disc Repeat or Track Repeat (or  
Repeat Off).  
Using the OSD  
1
During playback, press HOME MENU  
and select ‘Play Mode’.  
Play Mode  
2
Select ‘Repeat’ from the list of  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Disc Repeat  
Track Repeat  
Repeat Off  
functions on the left.  
Random  
Play Mode  
Program  
Search Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Title Repeat  
Chapter Repeat  
Repeat Off  
Random  
Program  
For MP3 discs, select Disc Repeat, Folder  
Search Mode  
Repeat or Track Repeat (or Repeat Off).  
Play Mode  
3
Select a repeat play option.  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Disc Repeat  
Folder Repeat  
Track Repeat  
Repeat Off  
If program play is active, select Program  
Repeat to repeat the program list, or Repeat  
Off to cancel.  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
For DVD-Video and DVD-RW discs, select  
Title Repeat or Chapter Repeat (or Repeat  
Off).  
Using the display unit  
During playback, press REPEAT to  
select a repeat play option.  
Press repeatedly until the repeat play option  
you want is shown in the display.  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Title Repeat  
Chapter Repeat  
Repeat Off  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
The repeat options are the same as those  
available from the OSD (see above).  
For DVD-Audio discs, select Group Repeat or  
Track Repeat (or Repeat Off).  
Play Mode  
• If you’ve created a program list, Program  
Repeat is also available.  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Group Repeat  
Track Repeat  
Repeat Off  
• During playback, you can cancel repeat  
Random  
play by pressing CLR.  
Program  
Search Mode  
• You can’t use repeat and random play at  
the same time.  
• If you switch camera angle during repeat  
play, repeat play is canceled.  
41  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
Playing discs  
For DVD-Audio discs, select Random Group  
or Random Track (or Random Off).  
Using random play  
Use the random play function to play titles or  
chapters (DVD-Video), groups or tracks (DVD-  
Audio), or tracks (SACD, CD, Video CD/Super  
VCD and MP3 discs) in a random order.  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Random Group  
Random Track  
Random Off  
You can set the random play option when a  
disc is playing or stopped.  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
For CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs, select On  
or Off to switch random play on or off.  
• You can’t use random play with VR format  
DVD-RW discs, Video CD/Super VCDs  
playing in PBC mode or while a DVD disc  
menu is being displayed.  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
On  
Off  
Random  
Using the OSD  
Program  
Search Mode  
1
During playback, press HOME MENU  
and select ‘Play Mode’.  
2
Select ‘Random’ from the list of  
For MP3 discs, select Random All (all folders)  
or Random Track (current folder only), (or  
Random Off).  
functions on the left.  
Play Mode  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Random Title  
Random Chapter  
Random Off  
Random  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Random All  
Random Track  
Random Off  
Program  
Search Mode  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
3
Select a random play option.  
For DVD-Video discs, select Random Title or  
Random Chapter, (or Random Off).  
Play Mode  
• You can also use the RANDOM button on  
the remote to select a random play mode.  
The random mode is indicated in the  
display unit and on-screen. The random  
modes available are the same as when  
choosing from the Play Mode menu.  
Press ENTER to start random play.  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Random Title  
Random Chapter  
Random Off  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
• To stop the disc and cancel random play-  
back, press (stop).  
42  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing discs  
05  
• To cancel random playback without stop-  
ping playback, press CLR. The disc will  
play to the end, then stop.  
3
Select ‘Create/Edit’ from the list of  
program options.  
Play Mode  
• During random play, the and ꢍ  
buttons function a little differently to  
normal: returns to the beginning of  
the current track/chapter. You can't go  
back further than this. selects  
another track/chapter at random from  
those remaining.  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Create/Edit  
Playback Start  
Playback Stop  
Program Delete  
Program Memory  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
Off  
• You can't use random play together with  
program or repeat play.  
The Program edit screen that appears  
depends on the kind of disc loaded.  
On the left side is the program list, then to the  
right is a list of titles (if a DVD-Video disc is  
loaded), groups (for DVD-Audio), tracks (for  
SACDs, CDs and Video CD/Super VCD), or  
folder names (for MP3 discs). On the far right  
is a list of chapters (for DVD-Video) or track  
names (for MP3).  
Creating a program list  
This feature lets you program the play order of  
titles/groups/chapters/folders tracks on a  
disc.  
4
Select a title, chapter, group, folder or  
track for the current step in the program  
list.  
For a DVD-Video disc, you can add a whole  
title, or a chapter within a title to the program  
list.  
• You can’t use Program play with VR  
format DVD-RW discs, Video CD/Super  
VCDs playing in PBC mode, or while a  
DVD disc menu is being displayed.  
• To add a title, select the title.  
Using the OSD  
Program  
1
During playback, press HOME MENU  
Program Step  
Title 1~38  
Chapter 1~4  
and select ‘Play Mode’.  
01. 01  
02.  
Title 01  
Title 02  
Title 03  
Title 04  
Title 05  
Title 06  
Title 07  
Title 08  
Chapter 001  
Chapter 002  
Chapter 003  
Chapter 004  
2
Select ‘Program’ from the list of  
03.  
04.  
functions on the left.  
05.  
06.  
07.  
Play Mode  
08.  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Create/Edit  
Playback Start  
Playback Stop  
Program Delete  
Program Memory  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
Off  
43  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
Playing discs  
• To add a chapter, first highlight the title,  
then press (cursor right) and select a  
chapter from the list.  
For an SACD, CD or Video CD/Super VCD,  
select a track to add to the program list.  
Program  
Program Step  
Track 1~12  
Program  
01. 04  
02.  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
Track 05  
Track 06  
Track 07  
Track 08  
Program Step  
Title 1-38  
Chapter 1-4  
01. 01-003  
02.  
Title 01  
Title 02  
Title 03  
Title 04  
Title 05  
Title 06  
Title 07  
Title 08  
Chapter 001  
Chapter 002  
Chapter 003  
Chapter 004  
03.  
04.  
03.  
05.  
04.  
06.  
05.  
07.  
06.  
08.  
07.  
08.  
For an MP3 disc, you can add a whole folder,  
or a track within a folder to the program list.  
For a DVD-Audio disc, you can add a whole  
group, or a track within a group to the  
program list.  
• To add a folder, select the folder.  
Program  
• To add a group, select the group.  
Program Step  
Folder 1-6  
Track 1-10  
01. 001  
02.  
001. ACP  
001. Gravity deluxe  
002.Tesla's patent  
003. Border dispute  
004. Delayed by rain  
005. Accident incident  
006. Pigeon post  
Program  
002. Nth Degree  
003. Pfeuti  
Program Step  
Group 1~38  
Track 1~4  
03.  
01. 01  
02.  
Group 01  
Group 02  
Group 03  
Group 04  
Group 05  
Group 06  
Group 07  
Group 08  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
04.  
004. Live  
05.  
005. Glitch music  
006. CodHead  
03.  
06.  
04.  
07.  
007. Outernational  
008. Vacuum tube  
05.  
08.  
06.  
07.  
08.  
• To add a track, first find the folder, then  
press (cursor right) and select a track  
name from the list.  
• To add a track, first highlight the group,  
then press (cursor right) and select a  
track from the list.  
Program  
Program Step  
Folder 1-6  
Track 1-10  
01. 001-003  
001. ACP  
001. Gravity deluxe  
002.Tesla's patent  
003. Border dispute  
004. Delayed by rain  
005. Accident incident  
006. Pigeon post  
Program  
02.  
03.  
04.  
05.  
06.  
07.  
08.  
002. Nth Degree  
003. Pfeuti  
Program Step  
Group 1-38  
Track 1-4  
01. 01-003  
02.  
Group 01  
Group 02  
Group 03  
Group 04  
Group 05  
Group 06  
Group 07  
Group 08  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
004. Live  
005. Glitch music  
006. CodHead  
03.  
04.  
007. Outernational  
008. Vacuum tube  
05.  
06.  
07.  
08.  
After pressing ENTER to select the title/  
chapter/group/folder/track, the step number  
automatically moves down one.  
5
Repeat step 4 to build up a program  
list.  
A program list can contain up to 24 titles/  
chapters/group/folders/tracks.  
44  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing discs  
05  
6
To play the program list, press ꢄ  
6
To add a step to the end of the  
(play).  
program list, highlight the next free step  
then select a title/chapter/group/folder/  
track to add.  
Program play remains active until you turn off  
program play (see below), erase the program  
list (see below), eject the disc or switch off the  
player or switched to a function other than  
DVD (CD).  
• To save your program list and exit the  
program edit screen without starting play-  
back, press HOME MENU.  
• To save your program list and exit the  
program edit screen without starting play-  
back, press HOME MENU. (Don’t press  
RETURN – your program list won’t be  
saved.)  
• If you want to exit the program edit screen  
without saving the changes you made,  
press RETURN.  
Other functions available from the OSD  
program menu  
As well as creating and editing a program list,  
you can start program play, cancel program  
play, erase the program list, and memorize a  
program list from the Play Mode menu.  
• During program play, press to skip to  
the next program step.  
• Press CLR during playback to switch off  
program play. Press while stopped to  
erase the program list.  
1
During playback, press HOME MENU  
Editing a program list using the OSD  
After creating a program list, you can add,  
delete and change steps.  
and select ‘Play Mode’.  
2
Select ‘Program’ from the list of  
functions on the left.  
1
During playback, press HOME MENU  
and select ‘Play Mode’.  
Play Mode  
2
Select ‘Program’ from the list of  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Create/Edit  
Playback Start  
Playback Stop  
Program Delete  
Program Memory  
functions on the left.  
Random  
Program  
3
Select ‘Create/Edit’ from the list of  
Search Mode  
Off  
program options.  
4
To clear a step, highlight the step  
number and press CLR.  
3
Select a program play function.  
Create/Edit – See above  
5
To insert a step in the middle of the  
program list, highlight the step where you  
want the new step to appear, then select  
a title/chapter/group/folder/track to add.  
After pressing ENTER, the new step is  
inserted into the list.  
Playback Start – Starts playback of a  
saved program list  
Playback Stop – Turns off program play,  
but does not erase the program list  
Program Delete – Erases the program  
list and turns off program play  
45  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
Playing discs  
Program Memory (DVD-Video only) –  
Select On to save the program list for the  
disc loaded. (Select Off to cancel the  
program memory for the disc loaded)  
4
To play the program list, press ꢄ  
(play).  
Program play remains active until you press  
(stop), clear the playlist (see below), eject  
the disc or switch off the player.  
Clearing the program list  
You must clear the program list to program a  
new one.  
• Program lists are saved for the DVD disc  
loaded. When you load a disc with a saved  
program list, program play is automati-  
cally turned on.  
1
2
If a disc is playing, press (stop).  
• You can save program lists for up to 24  
discs. After that, the oldest one is  
replaced with the new one saved.  
Press CLR.  
Searching a disc  
You can search DVD-Video discs by title or  
chapter number, or by time. DVD-Audio discs  
can be searched by group or track, or by page.  
SACDs, CD/Super VCDs can be searched by  
track number, and Video CDs by track  
number or time. MP3 discs can be searched  
by folder or track number.  
Using the unit display  
Even though the OSD is available for SACDs,  
CDs and MP3 discs, the Display unit provides  
enough information to make a program list  
easily. If a disc is playing, stop it first.  
1
Press PROGRAM.  
You’re prompted to enter a track or folder for  
the first step in the program list.  
1
During playback, press HOME MENU  
and select ‘Play Mode’.  
2
Select ‘Search Mode’ from the list of  
P - 0 0  
0 0 0  
functions on the left.  
The search options that appear depend on the  
kind of disc loaded. The screen below shows  
the DVD-Video search options.  
2
Use ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down) to select a  
track or a folder, then press ENTER.  
P - 0 1  
5 3 7  
Play Mode  
For MP3 discs only: To select an individual  
track within a folder, use the ꢀ/(cursor  
up/down) buttons to select the folder,  
then press , then use ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/  
down) to select a track. Press ENTER.  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Title Search  
Chapter Search  
Time Search  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
Wait for the display to prompt you after  
completing each selection. If you make a  
mistake, press CLR to delete the last (most  
recently) programmed track.  
3
Repeat step 2 to build up a program  
list.  
A program list can contain up to 24 steps.  
46  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing discs  
05  
3
4
Select a search mode.  
Playing DVD-Audio ‘Bonus  
Groups’  
Use the number buttons to enter a  
title, group, chapter, folder or track  
number, or a time or a page.  
Some DVD-Audio discs have an extra ‘bonus’  
group that requires a 4-digit key number to  
access. See the disc packaging for details  
and the key number. When you try and play  
the bonus group, the player will automatically  
ask you for the key number.  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Title Search  
Input Chapter  
Chapter Search  
Time Search  
0
0
1
Random  
Program  
1
Use the number buttons to enter the  
Search Mode  
4-digit key number.  
• It’s also possible to enter the key number  
from the Options menu. See page 69.  
• For a time search, enter the number of  
minutes and seconds into the currently  
playing title (DVD-Video/DVD-RW) or  
track (Video CD) you want playback to  
resume from.  
For example, press 4, 5, 0, 0 to have play-  
back start from 45 minutes into the disc.  
For 1 hour, 20 minutes and 30 seconds,  
press 8, 0, 3, 0.  
Switching subtitles  
Some DVD-Video discs have subtitles in one  
or more languages; the disc box will usually  
tell you which subtitle languages are avail-  
able. You can switch subtitle language during  
playback.  
Press SUBTITLE repeatedly to select a  
subtitle option.  
• Some DVD-Audio discs feature pages of  
browsable pictures. Enter the page  
number you want.  
Current / Total  
1/2  
Subtitle  
English  
5
Press ENTER to start playback.  
• Some discs only allow you to change  
subtitle language from the disc menu.  
Press TOP MENU to access.  
• You can only use time search with DVD-  
Video and Video CD discs.  
• The disc must be playing in order to use  
time search.  
• To set subtitle preferences, see Subtitle  
Language on page 65.  
• Search functions are not available with  
Video CD/Super VCDs in PBC mode, or  
unfinalized CD-R/RW discs.  
Switching DVD-Video audio  
language  
• With more than two SACD discs you may  
not be able to select the first track of discs  
after the second disc.  
When playing a DVD-Video disc recorded with  
dialog in two or more languages, you can  
switch audio language during playback.  
47  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
Playing discs  
Press AUDIO repeatedly to select an  
Press AUDIO repeatly to select an  
audio language option.  
audio channel option.  
Current /Total  
1/2  
Audio  
French  
Dolby Digital 3/2.1CH  
Audio  
Stereo  
Zooming the screen  
Using the zoom feature you can magnify a  
part of the screen by a factor of 2 or 4, while  
watching a DVD-Video, DVD-Audio or Video  
CD/Super VCD.  
• Some discs only allow you to change  
audio language from the disc menu.  
Press TOP MENU to access.  
• To set audio language preferences, see  
Audio Language on page 65.  
1
During playback, use the ZOOM  
button to select the zoom factor.  
Normal  
Switching DVD-Audio audio  
channels  
2x  
4x  
Depending on the disc, you may be able to  
switch channels when playing DVD-Audio  
discs—see the disc box for details.  
Normal  
1
Press AUDIO repeatedly to select an  
audio channel option.  
Digital Out Converted  
Linear PCM 192kHz24bit  
2CH  
Zoom 2x  
Zoom 2x  
Audio  
1
When you change the audio channel, play-  
back restarts from the beginning of the  
current track.  
Zoom 4x  
Zoom 4x  
• Some discs only allow you to change  
audio channel from the disc menu. Press  
TOP MENU to access.  
• Since DVD-Video, DVD-Audio and Video  
CD/Super VCD have a fixed resolution,  
picture quality will deteriorate, especially  
at 4x zoom. This is not a malfunction.  
• To set audio language preferences, see  
Audio Language on page 65.  
2
Use the cursor buttons to change the  
Switching Video CD/Super  
VCD audio channel  
zoomed area.  
You can change the zoom factor and the  
zoomed area freely during playback.  
When playing a Video CD/Super VCD you can  
switch between stereo, just the left channel or  
just the right channel.  
48  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing discs  
05  
• If the navigation square at the top of the  
screen disappears, press ZOOM again to  
display it.  
• DVD-Video displays  
Play  
DVD  
Current / Total Elapsed  
11/38 2.05  
Remain  
4.57  
Total  
7.02  
Title  
French  
Audio Dolby Digital 3/2.1CH  
English  
Subtitle  
1
Angle  
Play  
DVD  
• We do not recommend using DVD disc  
menus when the screen is zoomed as  
menu options will not be highlighted.  
Current / Total Elapsed  
11/38 2.05  
Remain  
4.57  
Total  
7.02  
Chapter  
Tr. Rate  
8.6Mbps  
• If you are displaying subtitles, these will  
disappear when the screen is zoomed.  
They will reappear when you return the  
screen to normal.  
• DVD-Audio displays  
Play  
DVD-Audio  
Current / Total  
1/14  
Elapsed  
3.20  
Remain  
2.41  
Total  
6.01  
Track  
Audio  
- -  
1
1
Linear PCM  
Subtitle  
Angle  
192kHz 24bit 2/0CH  
Switching camera angles  
-Audio  
DVD  
Play  
Some DVD-Video discs feature scenes shot  
from two or more angles—check the disc box  
for details.  
Current / Total  
1/3  
Elapsed  
3.21  
Remain  
53.20  
Total  
56.41  
Group  
Tr. Rate  
:
9.5Mbps  
• VR format DVD-RW displays  
When a multi-angle scene is playing, a  
icon appears on screen to let you know that  
other angles are available (this can be  
switched off if you prefer—see Angle Indicator  
on page 67).  
Play  
Title  
DVD-RW  
Original  
Elapsed  
0.08  
Current / Total  
1/32  
Remain  
30.22  
Total  
30.30  
1
- -  
Audio Dolby Digital  
2/0CH  
Subtitle  
During playback (or when paused),  
Play  
DVD-RW  
Original  
Current / Total  
1/1  
press ANGLE to switch angle.  
Chapter  
Tr. Rate  
4.3Mbps  
Displaying disc information  
• SACD displays  
Various track, chapter and title information,  
as well as the video transmission rate for DVD  
discs, can be displayed on-screen while a disc  
is playing.  
Play  
SACD  
Current / Total  
1/14  
Elapsed  
0.13  
Remain  
4.21  
Total  
4.34  
Track  
(During multichannel playback only)  
Play  
SACD  
Elapsed  
0.22  
OSD disc information  
Current / Total  
1/9  
Remain  
3.38  
Total  
4.00  
Track  
3/2.1CH  
To show/switch the information  
Audio  
displayed, press DISPLAY.  
When a disc is playing, the information  
appears at the top of the screen. Keep  
pressing DISPLAY to change the displayed  
information.  
Play  
Disc  
SACD  
Elapsed  
0.05  
Remain  
73.00  
Total  
73.05  
49  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
Playing discs  
• CD and Video CD displays  
Play  
CD  
Current / Total  
2/16  
Elapsed  
1.07  
Remain  
4.40  
Total  
5.47  
Track  
Play  
Disc  
CD  
Elapsed  
28.00  
Remain  
30.20  
Total  
58.20  
• (During PBC playback only.)  
Play  
VCD  
• Super VCD displays  
Play  
CD  
Current / Total  
2/16  
Elapsed  
1.07  
Track  
• MP3 disc displays  
Play  
MP3  
Current / Total  
1/17  
Elapsed  
0.18  
Remain  
12.42  
Total  
13.00  
Track  
Track Name  
Outernational  
Play  
MP3  
Current / Total  
2/7  
Folder  
Folder Name ACP  
• JPEG disc displays  
Play  
JPEG  
Current / Total  
1/40  
File  
File Name  
FL000001  
Play  
JPEG  
Current / Total  
2/6  
Folder  
Folder Name Holiday  
• You can see disc information (number of  
titles/chapters, tracks, groups, folders  
and so on) from the Disc Navigator  
screen. See Using the Disc Navigator to  
browse the contents of a disc on page 37.  
50  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing discs  
05  
Display unit information  
• Video CD displays  
Limited disc information also appears in the  
display unit. Press DISPLAY to change the  
displayed information.  
Track no.  
Elapsed disc time  
4
11 1 6  
Remaining disc time  
5 3 1 5  
3 2 0  
Disc  
• DVD-Video / DVD-RW displays  
Title no.  
Track no.  
Remaining track time  
2
2
8 4 9  
4
Chapter no.  
Elapsed title time  
• Super VCD displays  
Title no.  
2
2
TTL 1 0 7 0 0  
0 4 2  
Track no.  
Elapsed track time  
Remaining title time  
4
1 1 6  
Title no.  
2
• MP3 disc displays  
Chapter no.  
Remaining chapter  
time  
Track no.  
Elapsed track time  
2
0 3 5  
Track name  
E V E R Y B O D  
B E S T _ O F _  
• DVD-Audio displays  
Group no.  
Folder name  
2
2
2
2
8 4 9  
Track no.  
Elapsed track time  
• JPEG disc displays  
Group no.  
Track no.  
2
3 1 5  
File name  
T I G E R _ 0 1  
Remaining track time  
Folder name  
Group no.  
Remaining group time  
Z O O _ T R I P  
GRP 1 4 7 0 0  
• SACD / CD displays  
Track no.  
Elapsed track time  
4
4
1 1 6  
3 2 0  
Track no.  
Remaining track time  
Remaining disc time  
5 3 1 5  
Disc  
51  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
06  
Viewing JPEG discs  
Chapter 6  
Viewing JPEG discs  
Playing a JPEG slideshow  
After loading a CD/CD-R/RW containing  
• The , ANGLE and ZOOM buttons do not  
work while the display shows Loading.  
JPEG pictures, press to start a slideshow  
from the first folder/picture on the disc. The  
player displays the pictures in each folder in  
alphabetical order.  
• The time it takes for the player to load a file  
increases with large file sizes.  
Pictures are automatically adjusted so that  
they fill as much of the screen as possible (if  
the aspect ratio of the picture is different to  
your TV screen you may notice black bars at  
the sides, or at the top and bottom of the  
screen).  
• Up to 999 files are viewable on a disc. If  
there are more files than this on a disc,  
only the first 999 files are viewable.  
Using the JPEG Disc Navigator  
and Photo Browser  
While the slideshow is running:  
Use the JPEG Disc Navigator to find a  
particular folder or picture by filename on the  
disc in the play position; use the Photo  
Browser to find a picture within a folder by  
thumbnail image.  
Button  
What it does  
Pauses the slideshow; press  
again to restart.  
Displays the previous picture.  
Displays the next picture.  
1
Press DVD MENU to display the Disc  
Navigator screen.  
ANGLE  
Pauses the slideshow and  
rotates the currently displayed  
picture 90º clockwise. Press ꢄ  
(play) to restart slideshow).  
Disc Navigator  
Folder 1-2  
File 1-40  
001. FL000001  
002. FL000002  
003. FL000003  
004. FL000004  
005. FL000005  
006. FL000006  
007. FL000007  
008. FL000008  
JPEG  
001. F_001  
002. F_002  
ZOOM  
Pauses the slideshow and zooms  
the screen (see below). Press ꢄ  
(play) to restart slideshow).  
Displays the Disc Navigator  
screen (see below).  
DVD  
MENU  
The left column shows the folders on the disc,  
the right column shows the files in a folder.  
2
Use the cursor buttons (ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ) to  
Skip to the next/previous folder  
when playing a JPEG disc.  
FOLDER +/  
FOLDER –  
navigate.  
When a file is highlighted, a thumbnail image  
is displayed.  
52  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing JPEG discs  
06  
• When a folder is highlighted you can  
press ENTER to open the Photo Browser  
screen for that folder. See below for more  
on using the Photo Browser.  
1
During sldeshow playback, use the  
ZOOM button to select the zoom factor.  
• Normal  
• 2x  
• 4x  
3
To resume the slideshow from the  
highlighted file, press ENTER.  
Normal  
Using the Photo Browser  
The Photo Browser displays nine thumbnail  
images at a time from the current folder.  
1
From the Disc Navigator screen,  
Zoom 2x  
Zoom 4x  
highlight a folder to display then press  
ENTER.  
The Photo Browser screen opens with the first  
nine pictures displayed as thumbnails.  
Photo Browser  
2 / 40 Live at Soft  
• The slideshow is paused when the screen  
is zoomed.  
2
Use the cursor buttons (ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ) to  
• Since JPEG pictures have a fixed  
resolution, picture quality may  
deteriorate, especially at 4x zoom. This is  
not a malfunction.  
highlight a thumbnail picture.  
• Use the track skip buttons (and )  
to see the previous / next page of  
thumbnails. Keep the button pressed if  
you want to skip several pages; release  
when you reach the page you want.  
2
Use the cursor buttons (ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ) to  
change the zoomed area.  
You can change the zoom factor and the  
zoomed area freely.  
• To return to the Disc Navigator screen,  
press RETURN.  
3
To resume the slideshow, press ꢄ  
3
Press ENTER to display the selected  
(play).  
thumbnail full size on screen.  
The slideshow resumes from the selected  
picture.  
Zooming the screen  
Using the zoom feature you can magnify a  
part of the screen by a factor of 2 or 4, while  
viewing pictures from a JPEG disc.  
53  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
07  
Using the timer  
Chapter 7  
Using the timer  
1
Select the source you want played.  
Setting the wake-up timer  
For example, press TUNER to select the radio  
as your source.  
Use the wake-up timer to set the system to  
switch on at any time and start playing  
whatever source you want.  
2
Prepare the source.  
For example, tune in the radio station you  
want to wake up to.  
3
Set the volume.  
• The clock must be set to the correct time  
for the wake-up timer to work properly  
(see Setting the clock on page 19).  
4
Press TIMER/CLOCK twice to reach the  
timer menu.  
5
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
STANDBY/ON  
buttons to select ‘Wake-Up?’ then press  
ENTER.  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
6
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘TimerEdit?’ then press  
ENTER.  
7
Set the switch-on time.  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down) buttons to set  
the hour, then press ENTER. Set the minute in  
the same way, pressing ENTER when you’re  
done.  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
8
Set the switch-off time.  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down) buttons to set  
the hour, then press ENTER. Set the minute in  
the same way, pressing ENTER when you’re  
done.  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
After pressing ENTER this last time, the wake-  
up indicator lights, and the switch-on, switch-  
off times, the function (DVD/CD, etc.) and  
volume are confirmed in the display.  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
9
Switch the system into standby mode.  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
The wake-up timer will not work if the system  
is left on!  
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
54  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the timer  
07  
• You can check the timer settings in  
standby by pressing TIMER/CLOCK twice.  
(Press TIMER/CLOCK once to display the  
current time.)  
Turning the wake-up timer on/off  
If the wake-up timer is on, it will switch on the  
system everyday at the time you have set.  
1
Press TIMER/CLOCK twice to reach the  
timer menu.  
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘Wake-Up?’ then press  
ENTER.  
3
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘Timer On?’ or ‘Timer  
Off?’.  
• You must have the timer set (see above) to  
select ON. The wake-up timer switches on  
and off according to your previous  
settings.  
4
Press ENTER.  
• The wake-up timer will automatically be  
canceled if the clock is reset.  
55  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
07  
Using the timer  
1
Press TIMER/CLOCK twice to reach the  
Setting the sleep timer  
timer menu.  
The sleep timer switches off the system after  
a specified time so you can fall asleep without  
worrying about it.  
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘Sleep?’ then press  
ENTER.  
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to select a switch-off time then  
press ENTER.  
Choose between the following options:  
• If you set the sleep timer while either the  
wake-up timer is active, the earlier switch  
off time takes priority.  
Sleep Auto – System switches off  
automatically after the currently playing  
SACD, CD, Video CD/Super VCD or MP3  
disc has finished.  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
Sleep 90 – System switches off after 90  
minutes  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
Sleep 60 – System switches off after an  
hour  
Sleep 30 – System switches off after 30  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
minutes  
ENTER  
Sleep Off – cancels the sleep timer  
MUTE  
SOUND  
4
To check how much time is left, repeat  
steps 1 and 2.  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
The remaining time is displayed momentarily.  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
Sleep Auto will not work with Video CD/  
Super VCDs during PBC playback or CDs  
in repeat play.  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
56  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Surround sound setup  
08  
CShuaprterr o8 und sound setup  
Setting up surround sound  
The Room Setup feature (page 20) is  
• When you change speaker distance and  
designed to give you a basic surround sound  
setup, however you can make the more  
detailed settings that may improve the  
surround sound in your listening room.  
channel level settings, these settings will  
override settings you made in the Room  
Setup.  
1
2
Press SYSTEM SETUP.  
STANDBY/ON  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
buttons to choose the setting you want to  
adjust.  
The current setting is shown for each option  
as you cycle through the display. See below  
for a full list and description of each.  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
buttons to adjust the setting.  
ENTER  
4
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to make other  
MUTE  
SOUND  
settings.  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
5
When you’re done, press ENTER to  
leave the System Setup menu.  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
• The System Setup menu is exited  
automatically after 5 minutes of inactivity.  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
System Setup menu options  
Below are all the available settings in the  
setup menu. The first setting in each section  
is the default. See also the notes in each  
section for additional information about the  
settings.  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
57  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
08  
Surround sound setup  
Front speakers distance setting  
Specifies the distance from your listening  
position to the front speakers:  
Dual mono setting  
Specifies how dual mono encoded Dolby  
Digital or DTS soundtracks should be played.  
You can also use this setting to switch the  
audio channel on DVD-RW discs recorded  
with two separate soundtracks.  
Front 0.3 m ~ Front 9 m – Distance can  
be set in increments of 0.3 m. The default  
is 3 m.  
L-Ch1 R-Ch2 – Both channels are played  
through the front speakers  
Center speaker distance setting  
Specifies the distance from your listening  
position to the center speaker:  
Ch1 Mono – Only channel 1 is played  
Ch2 Mono – Only channel 2 is played  
Center 0.3 m ~ Center 9 m – Distance  
can be set in increments of 0.3 m. The  
default is 3 m.  
• On the Ch1 Mono and Ch2 Mono  
settings the sound comes only from the  
center speaker (or from the front speakers  
if listening in STEREO mode).  
Surround speakers distance setting  
Specifies the distance from your listening  
position to the surround speakers:  
• This setting works only with dual mono  
encoded Dolby Digital or DTS  
soundtracks. See the disc packaging for  
channel information.  
Surr. 0.3 m ~ Surr. 9 m – Distance can  
be set in increments 0.3 m. The default is  
3 m.  
Dynamic Range Control  
Specifies the amount of dynamic range  
adjustment to Dolby Digital or DTS  
soundtracks:  
LFE attenuator setting  
Dolby Digital and DTS audio sources include  
ultra-low bass tones. Set the LFE attenuator  
as needed to prevent the ultra-low bass from  
distorting the sound.  
DRC Off – No dynamic range adjustment  
(use when listening at higher volume)  
LFE ATT 0 – The LFE channel is played  
with no attenuation  
DRC Mid – Mid setting  
DRC High – Dynamic range is reduced  
(loud sounds are reduced in volume while  
quieter sounds are increased)  
LFE ATT 10 – LFE channel is attenuated  
by 10dB  
LFE Off – LFE channel is not played  
• This setting works only with Dolby Digital  
and some DTS soundtracks. For other  
sources you can create a similar effect  
using the Midnight mode (see Using  
Quiet and Midnight listening modes on  
page 34).  
58  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Surround sound setup  
08  
2
Switch the remote control to SUB,  
Setting the channel levels  
then press TEST TONE to hear the test  
tone.  
The test tone is output in the following order  
(from the speakers active in the current  
listening mode):  
You can set the relative channel levels from  
your main listening position for each listening  
mode, including all the Surround and  
Advanced Surround modes.  
If you used the Room Setup feature (page 20),  
the channel levels for each listening mode  
will already be set. However, you can still fine-  
tune the levels here if you need to.  
L – Front left speaker  
C – Center speaker  
R – Front right speaker  
RS – Right surround speaker  
LS – Left surround speaker  
SW – Subwoofer  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
3
Use the MASTER VOLUME +/– button  
to adjust the volume to an appropriate  
level.  
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
buttons to adjust the speaker levels in  
turn.  
ENTER  
You should hear the test tone at the same  
volume from each speaker when seated in the  
main listening position. The channel level  
range is 10 dB.  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
5
When you’re done, press ENTER to exit  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
test tone setup.  
BASS MODE DALG
VRAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
• The speaker volume can be adjusted  
while listening to any sound source you  
want by pressing CH LEVEL and then  
using the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down) buttons  
to adjust the channel levels. After you’re  
finished with one channel, use the ꢂ/ꢃ  
(cursor left/right) buttons to move to the  
next.  
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
1
Press SURROUND or ADVANCED  
repeatedly to select a listening mode.  
• Since the subwoofer produces ultra-low  
frequencies its sound may seem quieter  
than it actually is.  
59  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
09  
Video Adjust menu  
Chapter 9  
Video Adjust menu  
Creating your own presets  
You can create up to two presets of your own.  
Video Adjust  
• Default setting: Standard  
From the Video Adjust screen you can select  
the standard video presentation or define  
presets of your own.  
1
Select one of the Memory presets (see  
above).  
2
Press (cursor down) to select  
1
Press HOME MENU and select ‘Video  
‘Detailed Settings’ then press ENTER.  
Adjust’ from the on-screen display.  
Video Adjust  
Memory1  
HOME MENU  
DVD  
Detailed Settings  
Play Mode  
Video Adjust  
3
Adjust the picture quality settings.  
Disc Navigator  
Initial Settings  
Memory1  
Recall Settings  
Contrast  
Memory1  
min  
min  
min  
max  
max  
max  
Brightness  
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
Chroma Level  
buttons to select a preset.  
Video Adjust  
Standard  
• Use the ꢀ/(cursor up/down) buttons to  
select a setting.  
• Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right) buttons  
Standard – Normal  
to adjust the current setting.  
Memory1–2 – Use for saving your own  
presets (see below)  
• Press DISPLAY to switch between full and  
single view.  
3
Press ENTER to make the setting and  
• You can change the preset number from  
the Recall Settings menu item.  
exit the Video Adjust screen.  
• Depending on the disc and the TV/  
monitor, you may not see the effect  
clearly.  
60  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Video Adjust menu  
09  
You can adjust any or all of the following  
picture quality settings:  
Contrast – Adjusts the contrast between  
light and dark.  
Brightness – Adjusts the overall bright-  
ness.  
Chroma Level – Adjusts how saturated  
colors appear.  
4
Press ENTER to save the preset and  
exit the Video Adjust screen.  
61  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
Initial Settings menu  
Chapter 10  
Initial Settings menu  
Using the Initial Settings  
menu  
Digital Audio Mode Settings  
Make these settings if you connect an  
external digital component to the optical  
digital output. Note that DVD-Audio and  
SACD audio is not output through this jack.  
The Initial Settings menu gives you complete  
control in setting up your DVD system,  
including video output settings and parental  
lock settings, among others.  
Dolby Digital Out  
If an option is grayed out it means that it  
cannot be changed at the current time. This is  
usually because a disc is playing. Stop the  
disc, then change the setting.  
• Default setting: Dolby Digital  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Dolby Digital Out  
DTS Out  
Dolby Digital  
1
Press HOME MENU and select ‘Initial  
Dolby Digital > PCM  
Settings’ from the on-screen display.  
Linear PCM Out  
Display  
Options  
HOME MENU  
DVD  
Play Mode  
Video Adjust  
If the connected component is Dolby Digital  
compatible, set to Dolby Digital, otherwise  
set to Dolby Digital > PCM. Check the  
manual that came with the other component  
if you’re unsure whether it is Dolby Digital  
compatible.  
Disc Navigator  
Initial Settings  
2
Select the setup category from the list  
on the left, then select an item from the  
menu list to the right.  
DTS Out  
• Default setting: DTS  
3
Make the setting you want.  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Dolby Digital Out  
DTS Out  
DTS  
DTS > PCM  
Linear PCM Out  
• The language options shown in the on-  
screen display illustrations on the  
Display  
Options  
following pages may not correspond to  
those available in your country or region.  
If the connected component has a built-in  
DTS decoder, set this to DTS, otherwise set to  
DTS > PCM. Check the manual that came  
with the other component if you’re unsure  
whether it is DTS compatible.  
62  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initial Settings menu  
10  
Video Output settings  
• If you set to DTS with non-DTS compatible  
equipment, noise will be output when you  
play a DTS disc.  
TV Screen  
• Default setting: 16:9 (Wide)  
• DTS-CDs are always output as DTS digital  
audio regardless of this setting.  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
4:3 (Letter Box)  
4:3 (Pan&Scan)  
16:9 (Wide)  
TV Screen  
Component Out  
S-Video Out  
Linear PCM Out  
• Default setting: Down Sample Off  
Display  
Options  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Dolby Digital Out  
DTS Out  
Down Sample On  
Down Sample Off  
If you have a widescreen TV, select the 16:9  
(Wide) setting—widescreen DVD software is  
then shown using the full screen area. When  
playing software recorded in conventional  
(4:3) format, the settings on your TV will  
determine how the material is presented—  
see the manual that came with your TV for  
details on what options are available.  
Linear PCM Out  
Display  
Options  
If the connected component is compatible  
with high sampling rates (96 kHz), set this to  
Down Sample Off, otherwise set it to Down  
Sample On (96 kHz audio is converted to a  
more compatible 48 kHz). Check the manual  
that came with the other component if you’re  
unsure whether it is 96 kHz compatible.  
If you have a conventional TV, select either 4:3  
(Letter Box) or 4:3 (Pan & Scan). In Letter  
Box mode, widescreen software is shown with  
black bars at the top and bottom of the  
screen. Pan & Scan chops the sides off  
widescreen material to make it fit the 4:3  
screen (so even though the image looks  
larger on the screen, you’re actually seeing  
less of the picture). See also Screen sizes and  
disc formats on page 87.  
• Even when set to Down Sample Off,  
some discs will still output down-sampled  
audio through the digital outputs (you  
only get full sampling rate audio through  
the analog outputs).  
63  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
Initial Settings menu  
• If you connect a TV that is not compatible  
with a progressive scan signal and switch  
the system to progressive, you will not be  
able to see any picture at all. In this case,  
press STANDBY/ON to put the system  
in standby, then press and hold the front  
panel (stop) button for about 8 seconds  
until the display shows Mem.Clr.?. Press  
the front panel VOL – or + button so that  
the display shows Interlace?. Press the  
front panel button to set to interlace  
and switch the system back on.  
Component Out  
You only need to make this setting if you  
connected this system to your TV using the  
component video outputs.  
• Default setting: Interlace  
Initial Settings  
Video Output  
Language  
Display  
Interlace  
TV Screen  
Progressive  
Component Out  
S-Video Out  
Options  
Compatibility of this system with  
progressive-scan TVs.  
This system is compatible with progressive  
If you have a progressive-scan compatible TV,  
set this to Progressive for flicker-free video  
output. If your TV is not compatible with  
progressive-scan video, set to Interlace.  
Check the operating instructions that came  
with your TV if you’re unsure about its  
compatibility.  
video Macro Vision System Copy Guard.  
CONSUMERS SHOULD NOTE THAT NOT ALL HIGH  
DEFINITION TELEVISION SETS ARE FULLY  
COMPATIBLE WITH THIS PRODUCT AND MAY  
CAUSE ARTIFACTS TO BE DISPLAYED IN THE  
PICTURE. IN CASE OF 525 PROGRESSIVE SCAN  
PICTURE PROBLEMS, IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT  
THE USER SWITCH THE CONNECTION TO THE  
“STANDARD DEFINITION” OUTPUT. IF THERE ARE  
QUESTIONS REGARDING OUR TV SET  
When setting to Progressive, you have to  
press ENTER once more to confirm (or  
RETURN to cancel). See also below for  
important information on progressive scan  
video.  
COMPATIBILITY WITH THIS MODEL 525p DVD  
PLAYER, PLEASE CONTACT OUR CUSTOMER  
SERVICE CENTER.  
About progressive scan video  
Compared to interlace video, progressive  
scan video effectively doubles the scanning  
rate of the picture, resulting in a very stable,  
flicker-free image. Progressive scan video is  
available only from the component video  
output.  
This system is compatible with the following  
Pioneer displays and monitors: PDP-503HDG,  
PDP-433HDG progressive scan-compatible  
TVs.  
• When Component Out (above) is set to  
Progressive, there is no video output  
from the VIDEO and S-VIDEO jacks. If you  
want to display video on more than one  
monitor simultaneously, make sure that it  
is set to Interlace.  
64  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initial Settings menu  
10  
S-Video Out  
You only need to make this setting if you  
connected this system to your TV using an  
S-video cable.  
• You can switch between the languages  
recorded on a DVD-Video disc during  
playback using the AUDIO button. (This  
does not affect this setting.) See  
Switching DVD-Video audio language on  
page 47.  
• Default setting: S2  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
TV Screen  
S1  
S2  
• Some DVD-Video discs set the audio  
language automatically when loaded,  
overriding the Audio Language setting.  
Component Out  
S-Video Out  
Display  
Options  
• Discs with two or more audio languages  
usually allow you to select the audio  
language from the disc menu. Press DVD  
MENU to access the disc menu.  
• If you find that the picture is stretched or  
distorted on the default S2 setting, try  
changing it to S1.  
Subtitle Language  
• Default setting: English  
Language settings  
Initial Settings  
Audio Language  
• Default setting: English  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Audio Language  
Subtitle Language  
DVD Menu Lang.  
Subtitle Display  
English  
French  
Spanish  
Display  
Chinese  
Initial Settings  
Options  
Other Language  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Audio Language  
Subtitle Language  
DVD Menu Lang.  
Subtitle Display  
English  
French  
Spanish  
Display  
Chinese  
This setting is your preferred subtitle  
language for DVD-Video discs. If the language  
you specify here is recorded on a disc, the  
system automatically plays the disc with  
those subtitles.  
Options  
Other Language  
This setting is your preferred audio language  
for DVD-Video discs. If the language you  
specify here is recorded on a disc, the system  
automatically plays the disc in that language.  
The DVD-Video format recognizes 136  
different languages. Select Other Language  
if you want to specify a language other than  
those listed. See also Selecting languages  
using the language code list on page 87.  
The DVD-Video format recognizes 136  
different languages. Select Other Language  
if you want to specify a language other than  
those listed. See also Selecting languages  
using the language code list on page 87.  
65  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
Initial Settings menu  
Subtitle Display  
• Default setting: On  
• You can usually change or switch off the  
subtitles on a DVD-Video disc during  
playback using the SUBTITLE button.  
(This does not affect this setting.) See  
Switching subtitles on page 47.  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Audio Language  
Subtitle Language  
DVD Menu Lang.  
Subtitle Display  
On  
Off  
Display  
Options  
• Some DVD-Video discs set the subtitle  
language automatically when loaded,  
overriding the Subtitle Language  
setting.  
When set to On, the player displays subtitles  
according to the Subtitle Language setting.  
Set to Off to switch subtitles off altogether.  
• Discs with two or more subtitle  
languages usually allow you to select the  
subtitle language from the disc menu.  
Press DVD MENU to access the disc  
menu.  
Display settings  
OSD Language  
• Default setting: English  
DVD Menu Language  
• Default setting: w/Subtitle Lang.  
Initial Settings  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
OSD Language  
On Screen Display  
Angle Indicator  
English  
fran ais  
Español  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Audio Language  
Subtitle Language  
DVD Menu Lang.  
Subtitle Display  
w/Subtitle Lang.  
English  
French  
Display  
Display  
Spanish  
Options  
Options  
Chinese  
Other Language  
This sets the language of this system’s on-  
screen displays.  
Some multilingual discs have disc menus in  
several languages. This setting specifies in  
which language the disc menus should  
appear. Leave on the default setting for  
menus to appear in the same language as  
your Subtitle Language —see above.  
On Screen Display  
• Default setting: On  
Initial Settings  
The DVD-Video format recognizes 136  
different languages. Select Other Language  
if you want to specify a language other than  
those listed. See also Selecting languages  
using the language code list on page 87.  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
OSD Language  
On Screen Display  
Angle Indicator  
On  
Off  
Display  
Options  
66  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initial Settings menu  
10  
This sets whether operation displays are  
shown on-screen (Play, Resume, Scan and so  
on).  
• Not all discs that you may consider  
inappropriate for your children use the  
Parental Lock feature. These discs will  
always play without requiring the  
password first.  
Angle Indicator  
• Default setting: On  
Initial Settings  
• If you forget your password, you’ll need to  
reset the system to its factory settings  
(see Resetting the system on page 77),  
then register a new password.  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
OSD Language  
On Screen Display  
Angle Indicator  
On  
Off  
Display  
Options  
Registering a new password  
You must register a password before you can  
change the Parental Lock level or enter a  
Country code.  
If you prefer not to see the camera icon on-  
screen during multi-angle scenes on DVD  
discs, change this setting to Off.  
1
Select ‘Password’.  
Initial Settings  
Options  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Password  
Bonus Group  
Level Change  
Country Code  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Parental Lock  
• Default level: Off  
Display  
Options  
• Default password: none  
• Default Country code: us (2119)  
2
Use the number buttons to enter a 4-  
Some DVD-Video discs feature a Parental  
Lock level. If the player is set to a lower level  
than the disc, the disc won’t play. This gives  
you some control about what your children  
watch on your DVD system.  
digit password.  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock: Register Code Number  
Some discs also support the Country code  
feature. The player does not play certain  
scenes on these discs, depending on the  
Country code you set.  
*
*
*
*
Display  
Options  
Before you can set the Parental Lock level or  
the Country code you must register a  
password. As the password owner, you can  
change the Parental Lock level or Country  
code whenever you like. You can also change  
the password.  
The numbers you enter show up as asterisks  
(*) on-screen.  
67  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
Initial Settings menu  
3
Press ENTER to register the password  
4
Press ENTER to register the new  
and return to the Options menu screen.  
If you forget your password, you can reset the  
system then register a new one. See Resetting  
the system on page 77 for how to reset the  
system.  
password and return to the Options menu  
screen.  
Setting/changing the Parental Lock level  
1
Select ‘Level Change’.  
Changing your password  
Initial Settings  
To change your password, confirm your  
existing password then enter a new one.  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Password Change  
Level Change  
Bonus Group  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Country Code  
1
Select ‘Password Change’.  
Display  
Options  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Password Change  
Level Change  
Bonus Group  
2
Use number buttons to enter your  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Country Code  
password, then press ENTER.  
Display  
Options  
Initial Settings  
Parental Lock : Level Change  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Display  
Password  
*
*
*
*
2
Use the number buttons to enter your  
existing password, then press ENTER.  
The numbers appear as asterisks as you enter  
them.  
Options  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
off  
Initial Settings  
3
Select a new level.  
Parental Lock: Password Change  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Password  
Initial Settings  
*
*
*
*
Language  
Display  
Parental Lock : Level Change  
Password  
New Password  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Options  
*
*
*
*
Display  
Options  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
off  
3
Enter a new password.  
Initial Settings  
Press (cursor left) repeatedly to lock more  
levels (more discs will require the password);  
press (cursor right) to unlock levels. You  
can’t lock level 1.  
Parental Lock: Password Change  
Password  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Display  
New Password  
Options  
4
Press ENTER to set the new level and  
return to the Options menu screen.  
68  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initial Settings menu  
10  
• Select by code number: Press (cursor  
right) then use the number buttons to  
enter the 4-digit Country code (you can  
find the Country code list on page 88.)  
Setting/changing the Country code  
You may also want to refer to the Country code  
list on page 88.  
1
Select ‘Country Code’.  
Initial Settings  
Initial Settings  
Parental Lock: Country Code  
Digital Audio Mode  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Password Change  
Level Change  
Video Output  
Language  
Display  
Password  
*
*
*
*
Bonus Group  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Country Code  
Country Code List  
us  
Code  
Display  
Options  
2
1
1
9
Options  
4
Press ENTER to set the new Country  
2
Use number buttons to enter your  
code and return to the Options menu  
screen.  
password, then press ENTER.  
Initial Settings  
Parental Lock Change: Country Code  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Password  
*
*
*
*
• Changing the Country code does not take  
effect until the next disc is loaded (or the  
current disc is reloaded).  
Display  
Country Code List  
us  
Code  
Options  
2
1
1
9
Bonus Group  
3
Select a Country code.  
There are two ways you can do this.  
Initial Settings  
• Select by code letter: Use ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor  
Off (us)  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
up/down) to change the Country code.  
On  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Single  
Display  
Initial Settings  
DVD-Audio  
2ch Area  
Options  
Parental Lock: Country Code  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Display  
Password  
*
*
*
*
Country Code List  
us  
Code  
Some DVD-Audio discs have an extra ‘bonus’  
group that requires a 4-digit key number to  
access. See the disc packaging for details  
and the key number.  
Options  
2
1
1
9
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Bonus Group : Key Number Input  
Video Output  
Language  
_
_
_
_
Display  
Options  
69  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
Initial Settings menu  
When you play a DVD-Audio disc that has a  
bonus group, the key number input screen  
appears automatically. You can also access  
the same screen here.  
Group Playback  
• Default setting: Single  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
All  
Single  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Display  
Options  
• If you eject the disc, switch the power off,  
or unplug the player, you will need to re-  
enter the key number.  
DVD-Audio discs can have up to 9 groups of  
tracks. When set to Single, the selected  
group plays and then the disc stops, or  
returns to the menu screen. Use the search  
function (page 46) to select the group to play.  
(You cannot use the track skip / or  
scan buttons / in this mode.)  
Auto Disc Menu  
• Default setting: On  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
On  
Off  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Set to All if you want to play all the groups on  
a disc consecutively.  
Display  
Options  
This specifies whether the menu (Top menu)  
is automatically displayed after loading a  
disc. Set to On if you want the menu displayed  
automatically, or Off if you don’t want it  
displayed.  
• Even if the player is set to All but you  
select a group to play from the disc menu,  
only that group will play. If you stop  
playback, all groups will play again when  
you restart playback.  
DVD Playback Mode  
• Some DVD discs display a menu  
automatically regardless of this setting. If  
you press while a disc is loading, this  
setting is ignored.  
• Default setting: DVD-Audio  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
DVD-Audio  
DVD-Video  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Display  
Options  
Some DVD-Audio discs contain DVD-Video  
content in addition to the DVD-Audio. Set to  
DVD-Video to play a DVD-Audio disc as if it  
were a DVD-Video disc. Note that in this case  
only the DVD-Video part of the disc will play.  
70  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initial Settings menu  
10  
PhotoViewer  
Default setting: On  
• This setting reverts to DVD-Audio when  
the function is changed, the disc tray is  
opened, or the power is switched into  
standby.  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
On  
Off  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Display  
Options  
SACD Playback  
• Default setting: Multi-ch Area  
Initial Settings  
This setting is important if you load a disc that  
contains both MP3 audio files and JPEG  
picture files.  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
2ch Area  
Multi-ch Area  
CD Area  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
The default On setting allows you to view only  
the JPEG files on this kind of disc. Set to Off  
to be able to play the MP3 audio files.  
Display  
Options  
SACD discs can be divided up into several  
different areas — stereo audio (2ch Area),  
multi-channel audio (Multi-ch Area) and, for  
hybrid SACDs, standard CD audio (CD Area).  
Select which you want to listen to.  
• Changing the PhotoViewer setting does  
not take effect until the next disc is loaded  
(or the current disc is reloaded).  
• If you select an area that isn’t on the disc  
loaded, a different area will play. For  
example, if you choose standard CD audio  
but the disc loaded is not a hybrid SACD,  
the stereo SACD area will play.  
71  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
Other connections  
Chapter 12  
Other connections  
Connecting external antennas Connecting auxiliary  
components  
External AM antenna  
This system has both stereo analog inputs  
and outputs, as well as one optical digital  
inputs and one optical digital output. Use  
these to connect external components, such  
as your VCR, MD or CD-R recorder.  
Use 5–6 meters of vinyl-insulated wire and set  
up either indoors or outdoors. Leave the AM  
loop antenna connected.  
Outdoor antenna  
Connect the TV (IN) jacks to the audio  
outs of your TV (or VCR).  
This will enable you to hear the TV (or VCR)  
through this system. Connect using RCA pin-  
plug stereo cables. See also Reducing the TV  
and line signal levels on page 73.  
Indoor  
antenna  
(vinyl-coated  
wire)  
ENNA  
5–6 m  
BAL AM LOOP  
ANTENNA  
External FM antenna  
Use a 75coaxial cable to hook up an  
external FM antenna.  
AUDIO  
OUTPUT  
75coaxial cable  
LINE1  
VIDEO  
OUT  
S-VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
ATENNA  
LINE1  
OUT  
TV  
IN  
LINE1  
IN  
LINE2  
IN  
XV–DV900/XV–DV700  
FM UNBAL AM LOOP  
75  
ANTENNA  
72  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other connections  
11  
Connect the LINE 1 (IN) jacks to the  
Connect the LINE 1 (OPTICAL IN) jack  
analog outputs of an external playback  
component.  
These include components such as a VCR or  
cassette deck. Connect using RCA pin-plug  
stereo cables. See also Reducing the TV and  
line signal levels below.  
on the rear panel to the optical digital  
output of an external playback  
component.  
OPT  
ICAL  
DIGIT  
AL  
IN  
LINE  
1
Connect the LINE 1 (OUT) jacks to the  
analog inputs of an external recording  
component.  
These include components such as a  
cassette deck, VCR, MD or another recorder  
with analog inputs. Connect using RCA pin-  
plug stereo cables.  
These include digital components such as an  
MD player, digital satellite, or a game system.  
Connect using a optical digital cable (not  
supplied).  
Tape deck, etc.  
Reducing the TV and line signal  
levels  
• Default setting: ATT 6dB  
AUDIO  
INPUT  
AUDIO  
OUTPUT  
Some sources may produce a high signal  
level which may produce unpleasant  
distortion from the speakers. In such cases,  
you may need to reduce the signal level of the  
auxiliary source (connected to the TV or LINE  
1 or LINE 2 analog inputs) by switching on the  
attenuator.  
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.  
Press SYSTEM SETUP.  
CAL  
TAL  
N
LINE1  
VIDEO  
OUT  
S-VIDEO  
OUT  
O  
L
L
AUDIO  
AUD  
R
R
LINE1  
OUT  
TV  
IN  
LINE1  
IN  
LINE2  
IN  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘TV ATT?’ or ‘LINE1 ATT?’  
or ‘LINE2 ATT?’, then press ENTER.  
XV–DV900/XVDV700  
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
Connect the OPTICAL DIGITAL OUT  
buttons to select ‘ATT Off’, ‘ATT 6dB’ or  
‘ATT 10dB’.  
If the ATT 6dB setting still results in distorted  
sound, try the ATT 10dB setting.  
jack on the rear panel to the optical digital  
input of an external recording  
component.  
5
Press ENTER to confirm.  
OPTICAL  
DIGIT  
AL  
OUT  
73  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
Other connections  
Recording mode  
Connecting using the S-video  
output  
If your TV has an S-video input, you can use  
this instead of the standard video output for a  
better quality picture.  
The Recording mode allows you to make  
analog recordings from the LINE 1 (OUT)  
jacks.  
When Recording mode is on, most sound-  
related functions (including SURROUND,  
ADVANCED, AUTO, SYSTEM SETUP)  
become inactive. The display will briefly blink  
RecMode On if you try and use a prohibited  
function while Recording mode is on.  
Use an S-video cable (not supplied) to  
connect the S-VIDEO OUT to an S-video  
input on your TV.  
Line up the small triangle above the jack with  
the same mark on the plug before plugging  
in.  
When Recording mode is off, the audio from  
the analog output may be interrupted,  
depending on the operation.  
1
Press SOUND.  
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
S-VIDEO  
INPUT  
buttons to select ‘Rec Mode?’.  
3
Press ENTER.  
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
TV  
buttons to select ‘R.Mode On’ or ‘R.Mode  
Off’.  
• When Recording Mode is On a stereo  
downmix of multi-channel DVD-Audio  
and SACD discs is output from the  
speakers and from the analog audio  
jacks. Note that with some DVD-Audio  
disc, only the front left/right channels are  
output. When set to Off, multi-channel  
DVD-Audio and SACD discs are played  
through all the speakers, but front L/R  
audio is output from the analog audio  
jack.  
ANTENNA  
E1  
VIDEO  
OUT  
S-VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
AM  
ANTE  
L
L
AUDIO  
PR  
PB  
Y
R
NE1  
UT  
TV  
IN  
LINE1  
IN  
LINE2  
IN  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO OUT  
XV–DV900/XVDV700  
• The S-video ouptut is switchable between  
S1 and S2 formats for compatibility with  
all TVs. See S-Video Out on page 65 for  
more on this.  
• When R.Mode On is selected while  
playing SACD, the unit will loose speaker  
SW output and bass will become  
inaudible.  
74  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other connections  
11  
Connecting using the  
component video output  
If your TV has component video inputs, you  
can use these instead of the standard video  
output to connect this system to your TV. This  
should give you the best quality picture from  
the three types of video output available.  
Use a component video cable (not  
supplied) to connect the COMPONENT  
VIDEO OUT to a set of component inputs  
on your TV.  
COMPONENT  
INPUT  
ANTENNA  
FM BAL LOOP  
TENNA  
AUDIO  
E1  
LINE2  
IN  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO OUT  
N
XV–DV900/XVDV700  
• The component video ouptut is  
switchable between interlaced and  
progressive formats. See Component Out  
on page 64 for more on this.  
75  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
Chapter 12  
Additional information  
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
Switching off the demo  
buttons to select ‘Lock On?’ or ‘Lock Off?’.  
• Default setting: Demo On  
5
Press ENTER to confirm.  
This system has an automatic demo feature  
that starts when the system is plugged in for  
the first time.  
Changing the clock format  
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.  
Press SYSTEM SETUP.  
• Default setting: 12-Hour  
You can choose to display the clock in either  
12 or 24 hour formats.  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.  
Press SYSTEM SETUP.  
buttons to select ‘Demo Mode?’, then  
press ENTER.  
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘Demo Off?’ then press  
ENTER to confirm.  
buttons to select ‘12/24 Hour?’, then press  
ENTER.  
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to select either ‘12-Hour?’ or ‘24-  
Hour?’.  
• After setting the clock, the demo mode  
switches off automatically. However, if  
you unplug the system from the wall  
outlet, the demo mode will revert to Demo  
On (and the clock will be reset).  
5
Press ENTER to confirm.  
Changing the frequency step  
• Default setting: FM 100 AM 10  
If you find that you can’t tune into stations  
successfully, the frequency step may not be  
suitable for your country/region.  
Child Lock  
• Default setting: Lock Off  
This system has a child lock feature that  
makes the front panel buttons and controls  
inoperative.  
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.  
Press SYSTEM SETUP.  
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.  
Press SYSTEM SETUP.  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘FM AM Step?’, then  
press ENTER.  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to select ‘Child Lock?’, then press  
ENTER.  
buttons to select ‘FM 50 AM 9?’ or ‘FM 100  
AM 10?’ then press ENTER to confirm.  
76  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
Setting the TV format  
Watching NTSC on a PAL TV  
(MOD. PAL)  
• Default setting: AUTO  
The default setting of this system is AUTO,  
and unless you notice that the picture is  
distorted when playing some discs, you  
should leave it set to AUTO. If you experience  
picture distortion with some discs, set the TV  
system to match your country or region’s  
system. Doing this, however, may restrict the  
kinds of disc you can watch. The table below  
shows what kinds of disc are compatible with  
each setting (AUTO, PAL and NTSC).  
Most models of the newly developed count-  
down PAL TV system detect 50 Hz (PAL)/60 Hz  
(NTSC) and automatically switch vertical  
amplitude, resulting in a display without  
vertical shrinkage. However, in some cases,  
the image may appear without color.  
If your PAL TV does not have a V-Hold control,  
you may not be able to watch NTSC discs  
because of picture roll. If the TV has a V-Hold  
control, adjust it until the picture stops  
rolling.  
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.  
Press SYSTEM SETUP.  
On some TVs, the picture may shrink verti-  
cally, leaving black bands at the top and  
bottom of the screen. This is not a malfunc-  
tion; it is caused by the NTSC to PAL conver-  
sion.  
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)  
buttons to select ‘TV System?’, then press  
ENTER.  
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)  
buttons to select Auto, PAL or NTSC, then  
press ENTER to confirm.  
Resetting the system  
Use this procedure to reset all system  
settings (except for station memory) to the  
factory default.  
Disc  
Type  
DVD  
Player setting  
Format NTSC PAL  
NTSC NTSC  
PAL NTSC  
Video CD NTSC NTSC  
1
Switch the system into standby.  
AUTO  
2
Press and hold the top panel (Stop)  
MOD.PAL NTSC  
button for about 8 seconds until the  
display shows ‘Mem.Clr.?’.  
PAL  
PAL  
MOD.PAL NTSC  
3
Press the top panel button.  
The system’s settings are now reset, and you  
should see the ‘Welcome to Pioneer DVD !’  
screen.  
PAL  
NTSC  
NTSC  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
CD/no disc  
NTSC or  
PAL  
Dimming the display  
• Default setting: 3  
The display has three brightness levels (1–3).  
1
Press DIMMER to change the  
brightness level of the display unit.  
77  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
mark, which you can find on the rear panel.  
Discs from incompatible regions will not play  
in this player. Discs marked ALL will play in  
any player.  
Using and taking care of discs  
Titles, groups, chapters and tracks  
DVD discs are generally divided into one or  
more titles. Titles may be further subdivided  
into chapters.  
The diagram below shows the various DVD  
regions of the world.  
Title 1  
Title 2  
Title 3  
Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3 Chapter 1 Chapter 1 Chapter 2  
DVD-Audio discs are divided into one or more  
groups that can each contain a number of  
tracks.  
Group 1  
Track 1  
Group 2 Group 3  
Track 2  
Track 3  
Track 1  
Track 1  
Track 2  
CDs, SACDs and Video CD/Super VCDs are  
divided into tracks.  
Track 1 Track 2 Track 3 Track 4 Track 5 Track 6  
CD-ROMs contain folders and files. MP3 files  
are referred to as tracks. Folders may contain  
further folders.  
Folder A  
Track 1  
Folder B Folder C  
Track 2  
Track 3  
Track 1  
File 1  
File 2  
DVD Video regions  
All DVD Video discs carry a region mark on  
the case somewhere that indicates which  
region(s) of the world the disc is compatible  
with. Your DVD system also has a region  
78  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
Handling discs  
Storing discs  
When holding discs of any type, take care not  
to leave fingerprints, dirt or scratches on the  
disc surface. Hold the disc by its edge or by  
the center hole and edge.  
Although CDs and DVD discs are more  
durable than vinyl records, you should still  
take care to handle and store discs correctly.  
When you're not using a disc, return it to its  
case and store upright. Avoid leaving discs in  
excessively cold, humid, or hot environments  
(including under direct sunlight).  
Damaged or dirty discs can affect playback  
performance. Take care also not to scratch  
the label side of the disc. Although not as  
fragile as the recorded side, scratches can  
still result in a disc becoming unusable.  
Don't glue paper or put stickers onto the disc,  
or use a pencil, ball-point pen or other sharp-  
tipped writing instrument. These could all  
damage the disc.  
Should a disc become marked with  
fingerprints, dust, etc., clean using a soft, dry  
cloth, wiping the disc lightly from the center  
to the outside edge as shown in the diagram  
below.  
For more detailed care information see the  
instructions that come with discs.  
Do not load more than one disc into the player  
at a time.  
Wipe lightly from the center of the disc using  
straight strokes.  
Discs to avoid  
Discs spin at high speed inside the player. If  
you can see that a disc is cracked, chipped,  
warped, or otherwise damaged, don't risk  
using it in your player—you could end up  
damaging the unit.  
Don’t wipe the disc surface using circular  
strokes.  
If necessary, use a cloth soaked in alcohol, or  
a commercially available CD/DVD cleaning kit  
to clean a disc more thoroughly. Never use  
benzine, thinner or other cleaning agents,  
including products designed for cleaning  
vinyl records.  
This unit is designed for use with  
conventional, fully circular discs only. Use of  
shaped discs is not recommended for this  
product. Pioneer disclaims all liability arising  
in connection with the use of shaped discs.  
79  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
Cleaning the pickup lens  
Proper installation and  
The DVD player’s lens should not become  
dirty in normal use, but if for some reason it  
should malfunction due to dust or dirt,  
consult your nearest Pioneer authorized  
service center. Although lens cleaners are  
commercially available, we do not  
recommend using them since some may  
damage the lens.  
maintenance of this system  
Hints on installation  
We want you to enjoy using this system for  
years to come, so please bear in mind the  
following points when choosing a suitable  
location for it:  
Do...  
Problems with condensation  
Condensation may form inside the player if it  
is brought into a warm room from outside, or  
if the temperature of the room rises quickly.  
Although the condensation won’t damage the  
player, it may temporarily impair its  
performance. For this reason you should  
leave it to adjust to the warmer temperature  
for about an hour before switching on and  
using.  
Use in a well-ventilated room.  
Place on a solid, flat, level surface, such  
as a table, shelf or stereo rack.  
Don’t...  
Use in a place exposed to high  
temperatures or humidity, including near  
radiators and other heat-generating  
appliances.  
Place on a window sill or other place  
where the system will be exposed to direct  
sunlight.  
Moving the system unit  
Use in an excessively dusty or damp  
environment.  
If you need to move the main unit, first remove  
a disc if there’s one in the player, then press  
STANDBY/ON on the front panel to turn  
the system off. Wait for Good Bye to  
disappear from the display, then unplug the  
power cable. Never lift or move the unit during  
playback—discs rotate at a high speed and  
may be damaged.  
Place directly on top of an amplifier, or  
other component in your stereo system  
that becomes hot in use.  
Use near a television or monitor as you  
may experience interference—especially  
if the television uses an indoor antenna.  
Use in a kitchen or other room where the  
system may be exposed to smoke or  
steam.  
• Unplugging the unit before Good Bye  
disappears from the display may cause  
the system to return to the factory  
settings.  
Use on a thick rug or carpet, or cover with  
cloth—this may prevent proper cooling of  
the system.  
Place on an unstable surface, or one that  
is not large enough to support all four of  
the unit’s feet.  
80  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
Power cord caution  
Handle the power cord by the plug. Do not  
pull out the plug by tugging the cord and  
never touch the power cord when your hands  
are wet as this could cause a short circuit or  
an electric shock. Do not place this unit, a  
piece of furniture, etc., on the power cord, or  
pinch the cord. Never make a knot in the cord  
or tie it with other cords. The power cords  
should be routed such that they are not likely  
to be stepped on. A damaged power cord can  
cause a fire or give you an electrical shock.  
Check the power cord once in a while. When  
you find it damaged, ask your nearest Pioneer  
authorized service center or your dealer for a  
replacement.  
81  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
Troubleshooting  
Incorrect operations are often mistaken for trouble and malfunctions. If you think that there is  
something wrong with this component, check the points below. Sometimes the trouble may lie  
in another component. Investigate the other components and electrical appliances being used.  
If the trouble cannot be rectified even after exercising the checks listed below, ask your nearest  
Pioneer authorized service center or your dealer to carry out repair work.  
• If the system does not operate normally due to external effects such as static electricity  
disconnect the power plug from the outlet and insert again to return to normal operating  
conditions.  
General  
Problem  
Remedy  
The power does not  
turn on.  
• Connect the power plug to the wall outlet.  
• Disconnect the power plug from the outlet, and insert again.  
• Make sure there are no loose strands of speaker wire touching the rear  
panel. This could cause the system to shut off automatically.  
No sound is output  
when a function is  
selected.  
• If you’re using the line input, make sure the component is connected  
correctly (see Connecting auxiliary components on page 72).  
• Press MUTE on the remote control to turn muting off.  
• Adjust the VOLUME.  
No image is output  
when playing discs.  
• Make sure the TV is connected correctly (refer to the Setup Guide).  
• Reset the video output to interlace (see Component Out on page 64)  
No sound from  
surround or center  
speakers.  
• Refer to Setting the channel levels on page 59 to check the speaker levels.  
• Check that you haven’t selected the STEREO sound mode (see Listening  
in surround sound on page 30).  
• Check that the Virtual mode is not on (Using the Advanced Surround  
effects on page 32).  
• Connect the speakers properly (refer to the Setup Guide).  
Can’t operate the  
remote control.  
• Replace the batteries (refer to the Setup Guide).  
• Operate within 23 ft. (7 m), 30° of the remote sensor on the display unit  
(refer to the Setup Guide).  
• Remove any obstacles or operate from another position.  
• Avoid exposing the remote sensor on the display unit to direct light.  
No display  
• Make sure everything is connected properly.  
82  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
Problem  
Remedy  
Timer indicator is  
blinking and the  
• Unplug the unit, then plug back in. Wait for one minute then switch on.  
• Make sure the fan at the AMP section of the unit is not being blocked.  
system will not switch • Check that the speakers are connected correctly.  
on.  
• If the problem persists, take it to your nearest Pioneer  
authorized service center or your dealer for servicing.  
DVD/CD/Video CD player  
Problem  
Remedy  
The disc is ejected  
automatically after  
loading.  
• Clean the disc.  
• Align the disc properly in the disc guide.  
• If the region number on a DVD-video disc does not match the number on  
the player, the disc cannot be used (see DVD Video regions on page 78).  
• Allow time for any condensation inside the player to evaporate. Avoid  
using the player near an air-conditioning unit.  
Playback is not  
possible.  
• If the disc is loaded upside down, reload the disc with the label side face  
up.  
Picture playback stops  
and the operation  
buttons cannot be  
used.  
• Press (stop), then (play) to start playback again.  
• Switch the power off once, then on again using the front panel  
STANDBY/ON button.  
Settings are canceled. • When the power is cut due to power failure or by unplugging the power  
cable, settings will be canceled.  
No picture/No color.  
• Check that connections are correct and that plugs are inserted fully.  
• Check the instruction manual of the TV/monitor to make sure the TV/  
monitor settings are incorrect.  
• If your TV/monitor is connected using an S-video cable, try changing the  
S-Video Out setting (see S-Video Out on page 65).  
Screen is stretched or  
aspect does not  
change.  
• The TV Screen setting is incorrect. Set the TV Screen option to match the  
TV/monitor you're using (see TV Screen on page 63).  
When recorded on a  
• This system uses copy-protection technology which may prevent  
VCR or passed through recording or cause picture problems when connected through a VCR or AV  
an AV selector, there is selector. This is not a malfunction.  
disturbance in the  
playback picture.  
83  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
Problem  
Remedy  
Picture disturbance  
during playback or  
dark.  
• This player is compatible with Macro-Vision System copy guard. Some  
discs include a copy prevention signal, and when this type of disc is played  
back, stripes etc., may appear on some sections of the picture depending  
on the TV. This is not a malfunction.  
• Discs respond differently to particular player functions. This may result in  
the screen becoming black for a brief instant or shaking slightly when the  
function is executed. These problems are largely due to differences  
between discs and disc content and are not malfunctions of this player.  
Noticeable difference  
in DVD and CD  
volume.  
• DVDs and CDs use different recording methods. This is not a  
malfunction.  
Incompletesoundfrom  
headphones when  
listening to a DVD-  
Audio disc.  
• Some multichannel DVD-Audio discs only output the front/right  
channels through headphones.  
MP3/JPEG discs  
Problem  
Remedy  
CD-ROM disc is not  
recognized by the  
system.  
• Make sure that the CD-ROM was recorded using the ISO 9660 disc  
format. See General disc compatibility on page 9 for other disc compatibility  
information.  
Files don’t show up in • The files on the disc must be named with the correct file extention: .mp3  
the Disc Navigator/  
Photo Browser.  
for MP3 files; .jpg for JPEG files (upper or lower-case is OK). See General  
disc compatibility on page 9 for other disc compatibility information.  
JPEG files appear, but • Set the PhotoViewer menu option in the Initial Settings menu to Off to  
MP3 files don’t show  
up.  
be able to access the MP3 files. See PhotoViewer on page 71.  
84  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
Tuner  
Problem  
Considerable noise in • Connect the antenna (refer to the Setup Guide).  
radio broadcasts. • Fully extend the FM wire antenna, position for best reception, and secure  
Remedy  
to a wall.  
• Connect an outdoor FM antenna (see Connecting external antennas on  
page 72).  
• Adjust the direction and position for best reception.  
• Connect an additional internal or external AM antenna (refer to the Setup  
Guide and Connecting external antennas on page 72).  
Turn off any other equipment that may be causing the noise or move it  
away from the main unit.  
• The tuning interval is incorrect for your country or region. Try switching  
the tuning interval (frequency step) (see Changing the frequency step on  
page 76).  
Auto tuning does not • The radio signal is weak. Auto tuning will only detect radio stations with a  
pick up some stations. good signal. For more sensitive tuning, connect an outdoor antenna.  
Sound is mono only.  
• Check that the tuner is not set to FM mono (see Improving poor FM  
reception on page 28).  
Error Messages  
Message  
Desciption  
Child Lock  
• This message appears when the front panel buttons are pressed when  
the child lock feature is active. See Child Lock on page 76 for more on  
switching on/off the child lock.  
Rec Mode On  
Phones In  
96K Stereo  
No Surr. SP  
Muting  
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because the  
Recording Mode is on (see Recording mode on page 74).  
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because  
headphones are connected.  
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because the  
source is digital 88.2 or 96kHz PCM.  
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because  
there is no surround speaker output.  
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because the  
sound is muted (see Muting the sound on page 36).  
Exit  
• Appears briefly when a menu is automatically exited after a set period of  
inactivity.  
85  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
Message  
Desciption  
DVD-AUDIO  
• Blinks rapidly when one of the below buttons is pressed while a DVD-  
Audio disc is loaded.  
·AUTO ·SURROUND ·ADVANCED ·DIALOGUE ·VIRTUAL SB  
·BASS MODE  
SACD  
• Blinks rapidly when one of the below buttons is pressed while a SACD  
disc is loaded.  
·AUTO ·SURROUND ·ADVANCED ·DIALOGUE ·VIRTUAL SB  
·BASS MODE  
86  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
options; see the  
instructions that  
came with your TV for widescreen discs are  
Set to 4:3  
(Pan&Scan),  
Screen sizes  
and disc  
Selecting  
languages  
using the  
language  
details.  
shown with the left  
and right sides  
cropped. Although  
the picture looks  
larger, you don’t  
actually see the whole options (see  
picture.  
formats  
DVD-Video discs  
come in several  
Please note that  
some movie aspect  
ratios are wider than  
16:9, so even though  
you have a  
widescreen TV, these  
discs will still play in a  
‘letterbox’ style with  
black bars at the top  
and bottom of the  
screen.  
code list  
different screen  
Some of the language  
aspects, rangingfrom  
TV programs, which  
are generally 4:3, to  
CinemaScope  
widescreen movies,  
with an aspect ratio of  
up to about 7:3.  
Language settings on  
page 65) allow you to  
set your prefered  
language from any of  
the 136 languages  
listed in the Language  
code list on page 88.  
Televisions also come  
in different aspect  
ratios; ‘standard’ 4:3  
and widescreen 16:9.  
Please note that  
many widescreen  
discs override the  
system’s settings so  
that the disc is shown  
in letterbox format  
regardless of the  
setting.  
1
Select ‘Other  
Standard TV  
users  
Language’.  
If you have a standard  
TV, the TV Screen  
setting (page 63) of  
this system should be  
set to 4:3 (Letter  
Box) or 4:3  
(Pan&Scan),  
depending on which  
you prefer.  
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ  
Widescreen TV  
users  
If you have a  
widescreenTV, the TV  
Screen setting  
(page 63) of this  
system should be set  
to 16:9 (Wide).  
(cursor left/right)  
buttons to select  
either a code letter  
or a code number.  
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ  
(cursor up/down)  
buttons to select a  
code letter or a code  
number.  
See the Language  
code list on page 88  
(next page) for a  
complete list of  
• Using the 16:9  
(Wide) setting  
Set to 4:3 (Letter  
Box), widescreen  
discs are shown with  
black bars top and  
bottom.  
When you watch  
discs recorded in 4:3  
format, you can use  
the TV controls to  
select how the picture  
is presented. Your TV  
may offer various  
with a standard  
4:3 TV, or either of  
the 4:3 settings  
with a widescreen  
TV, will result in a  
distorted picture.  
languages and codes.  
zoom and stretch  
87  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
Language code list  
Language (Language code letter), Language code  
Japanese (ja), 1001  
English (en), 0514  
French (fr), 0618  
German (de), 0405  
Italian (it), 0920  
Spanish (es), 0519  
Dutch (nl), 1412  
Russian (ru), 1821  
Chinese (zh), 2608  
Korean (ko), 1115  
Greek (el), 0512  
Basque (eu), 0521  
Persian (fa), 0601  
Finnish (fi), 0609  
Fiji (fj), 0610  
Faroese (fo), 0615  
Frisian (fy), 0625  
Lithuanian (lt), 1220  
Latvian (lv), 1222  
Malagasy (mg), 1307  
Maori (mi), 1309  
Macedonian (mk), 1311  
Malayalam (ml), 1312  
Mongolian (mn), 1314  
Moldavian (mo), 1315  
Marathi (mr), 1318  
Malay (ms), 1319  
Maltese (mt), 1320  
Burmese (my), 1325  
Nauru (na), 1401  
Samoan (sm), 1913  
Shona (sn), 1914  
Somali (so), 1915  
Albanian (sq), 1917  
Serbian (sr), 1918  
Siswati (ss), 1919  
Sesotho (st), 1920  
Sundanese (su), 1921  
Swedish (sv), 1922  
Swahili (sw), 1923  
Tamil (ta), 2001  
Telugu (te), 2005  
Tajik (tg), 2007  
Thai (th), 2008  
Tigrinya (ti), 2009  
Turkmen (tk), 2011  
Tagalog (tl), 2012  
Setswana (tn), 2014  
Tonga (to), 2015  
Turkish (tr), 2018  
Irish (ga), 0701  
Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704  
Galician (gl), 0712  
Guarani (gn), 0714  
Gujarati (gu), 0721  
Hausa (ha), 0801  
Hindi (hi), 0809  
Croatian (hr), 0818  
Hungarian (hu), 0821  
Armenian (hy), 0825  
Interlingua (ia), 0901  
Interlingue (ie), 0905  
Inupiak (ik), 0911  
Indonesian (in), 0914  
Icelandic (is), 0919  
Hebrew (iw), 0923  
Yiddish (ji), 1009  
Javanese (jw), 1023  
Georgian (ka), 1101  
Kazakh (kk), 1111  
Greenlandic (kl), 1112  
Cambodian (km), 1113  
Kannada (kn), 1114  
Kashmiri (ks), 1119  
Kurdish (ku), 1121  
Kirghiz (ky), 1125  
Latin (la), 1201  
Afar (aa), 0101  
Abkhazian (ab), 0102  
Afrikaans (af), 0106  
Amharic (am), 0113  
Arabic (ar), 0118  
Assamese (as), 0119  
Aymara (ay), 0125  
Azerbaijani (az), 0126  
Bashkir (ba), 0201  
Byelorussian (be), 0205  
Bulgarian (bg), 0207  
Bihari (bh), 0208  
Bislama (bi), 0209  
Bengali (bn), 0214  
Tibetan (bo), 0215  
Breton (br), 0218  
Catalan (ca), 0301  
Corsican (co), 0315  
Czech (cs), 0319  
Nepali (ne), 1405  
Norwegian (no), 1415  
Occitan (oc), 1503  
Oromo (om), 1513  
Oriya (or), 1518  
Panjabi (pa), 1601  
Polish (pl), 1612  
Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619 Tsonga (ts), 2019  
Portuguese (pt), 1620  
Quechua (qu), 1721  
Rhaeto-Romance (rm),  
1813  
Kirundi (rn), 1814  
Romanian (ro), 1815  
Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823  
Sanskrit (sa), 1901  
Sindhi (sd), 1904  
Sangho (sg), 1907  
Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908  
Sinhalese (si), 1909  
Slovak (sk), 1911  
Tatar (tt), 2020  
Twi (tw), 2023  
Ukrainian (uk), 2111  
Urdu (ur), 2118  
Uzbek (uz), 2126  
Vietnamese (vi), 2209  
Volapük (vo), 2215  
Wolof (wo), 2315  
Xhosa (xh), 2408  
Yoruba (yo), 2515  
Zulu (zu), 2621  
Welsh (cy), 0325  
Danish (da), 0401  
Bhutani (dz), 0426  
Esperanto (eo), 0515  
Estonian (et), 0520  
Lingala (ln), 1214  
Laothian (lo), 1215  
Slovenian (sl), 1912  
Country code list  
Country, Country code, Country code letter  
Argentina, 0118, ar  
Australia, 0121, au  
Austria, 0120, at  
Belgium, 0205, be  
Brazil, 0218, br  
Canada, 0301, ca  
Chile, 0312, cl  
China, 0314, cn  
Denmark, 0411, dk  
Finland, 0609, fi  
France, 0618, fr  
Germany, 0405, de  
Hong Kong, 0811, hk  
India, 0914, in  
Indonesia, 0904, id  
Italy, 0920, it  
Japan, 1016, jp  
Korea, Republic of, 1118,  
kr  
Mexico, 1324, mx  
Spain, 0519, es  
Switzerland, 0308, ch  
Sweden, 1905, se  
Taiwan, 2023, tw  
Thailand, 2008, th  
United Kingdom, 0702, gb  
United States of America,  
Netherlands, 1412, nl  
New Zealand, 1426, nz  
Norway, 1415, no  
Pakistan, 1611, pk  
Philippines, 1608, ph  
Portugal, 1620, pt  
Russian Federation, 1821, 2119, us  
ru  
Singapore, 1907, sg  
Malaysia, 1325, my  
88  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
Preset code list  
Please note that there are cases where only certain functions may be controllable after  
assigning the proper preset code, or the codes for the manufacturer in the list will not work for  
the model that you are using.  
MANUFACTURER Code(s)  
ACURA 644  
ERRES 607  
ITC 642  
OSUME 648  
ADMIRAL 631  
AIWA 660  
AKAI 632, 635, 642  
AKURA 641  
FERGUSON 607, 636, 651  
FINLANDIA 635, 643, 655  
FINLUX 632, 607, 645, 648, JVC 613, 623  
ITT 631, 632, 642  
JEC 605  
OTTO VERSAND 631, 632,  
607, 642  
PALLADIUM 638  
PANAMA 646  
653, 654, 655  
KAISUI 618, 641, 644  
ALBA 607, 639, 641, 644  
AMSTRAD 642, 644, 647  
ANITECH 644  
ASA 645  
FIRSTLINE 640, 644  
KAPSCH 631  
KENDO 642  
KENNEDY 632, 642  
KORPEL 607  
PANASONIC 631, 607,  
608,642, 622  
PATHO CINEMA 642  
PAUSA 644  
PHILCO 632, 642  
PHILIPS 631, 607, 634, 656  
PHOENIX 632  
FISHER 632, 635, 638, 645  
FORMENTI 632, 607, 642  
FRONTECH 631, 642, 646  
ASUKA 641  
FRONTECH/PROTECH 632 KOYODA 644  
AUDIOGONIC 607, 636  
BASIC LINE 641, 644  
BAUR 631, 607, 642  
BEKO 638  
FUJITSU 648, 629  
FUNAI 640, 646, 658  
GBC 632, 642  
GE 601, 608, 607, 610, 617, LUXOR 632, 642, 643  
602, 628, 618  
GEC 607, 634, 648  
GELOSO 632, 644  
GENEXXA 631, 641  
LEYCO 607, 640, 646, 648  
LIESENK&TTER 607  
LOEWE 607  
PHONOLA 607  
PROFEX 642, 644  
PROTECH 607, 642, 644,  
646, 649  
QUELLE631, 632, 607, 642,  
645, 653  
BEON 607  
M-ELECTRONIC 631, 644,  
645, 654, 655, 656, 607,  
636, 651  
BLAUPUNKT 631  
BLUE SKY 641  
BLUE STAR 618  
BPL 618  
MAGNADYNE 632, 649  
GOLDSTAR 610, 623, 621, MAGNAFON 649  
R-LINE 607  
BRANDT 636  
BTC 641  
602, 607, 650  
GOODMANS 607, 639,  
647, 648, 656  
GORENJE 638  
GPM 641  
GRAETZ 631, 642  
GRANADA 607, 635, 642,  
643, 648  
GRADIENTE 630, 657  
GRANDIN 618  
GRUNDIG 631, 653  
HANSEATIC 607, 642  
HCM 618, 644  
MAGNAVOX 607, 610,  
603, 612, 629  
MANESTH 639, 646  
MARANTZ 607  
MARK 607  
MATSUI 607, 639, 640,  
642, 644, 647, 648  
MCMICHAEL 634  
MEDIATOR 607  
MEMOREX 644  
METZ 631  
RADIOLA 607  
RADIOSHACK 610, 623,  
621, 602  
BUSH 607, 641, 642, 644,  
647, 656  
CASCADE 644  
CATHAY 607  
CENTURION 607  
CGB 642  
RBM 653  
RCA 601, 610, 615, 616,  
617, 618, 661, 662, 609  
REDIFFUSION 632, 642  
REX 631, 646  
ROADSTAR 641, 644, 646  
SABA 631, 636, 642, 651  
SAISHO 639, 644, 646  
SALORA 631, 632, 642, 643  
CIMLINE 644  
CLARIVOX 607  
CLATRONIC 638  
CONDOR 638  
CONTEC 644  
MINERVA 631, 653  
MITSUBISHI 609, 610, 602, SAMBERS 649  
CROSLEY 632  
CROWN 638, 644  
CRYSTAL 642  
CYBERTRON 641  
DAEWOO 607, 644, 656  
DAINICHI 641  
DANSAI 607  
DAYTON 644  
DECCA 607, 648  
DIXI 607, 644  
DUMONT 653  
ELIN 607  
HINARI 607, 641, 644  
HISAWA 618  
HITACHI 631, 633, 634,  
636, 642, 643, 654, 606,  
610, 624, 625, 618  
HUANYU 656  
HYPSON 607, 618, 646  
ICE 646, 647  
IMPERIAL 638, 642  
INDIANA 607  
INGELEN 631  
INTERFUNK 631, 632, 607, OCEANIC 631, 632, 642  
642  
INTERVISION 646, 649  
ISUKAI 641  
621, 631  
MULTITECH 644, 649  
NEC 659  
NECKERMANN 631, 607  
NEI 607, 642  
NIKKAI 605, 607, 641, 646, SCHAUB LORENZ 642  
SAMSUNG 607, 638, 644,  
646  
SANYO 635, 645, 648, 621,  
614  
SBR 607, 634  
648  
SCHNEIDER 607, 641, 647  
SEG 642, 646  
SEI 632, 640, 649  
SELECO 631, 642  
SHARP 602, 619, 627  
SIAREM 632, 649  
SIEMENS 631  
NOBLIKO 649  
NOKIA 632, 642, 652  
NORDMENDE 632, 636,  
651, 652  
ELITE 641  
ELTA 644  
EMERSON 642  
ORION 632, 607, 639, 640  
OSAKI 641, 646, 648  
OSO 641  
SINUDYNE 632, 639, 640,  
649  
89  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
SKANTIC 643  
SOLAVOX 631  
SONOKO 607, 644  
SONOLOR 631, 635  
SONTEC 607  
SONY 604  
SOUNDWAVE 607  
STANDARD 641, 644  
STERN 631  
SUSUMU 641  
SYSLINE 607  
TANDY 631, 641, 648  
TASHIKO 634  
TATUNG 607, 648  
TEC 642  
TELEAVIA 636  
TELEFUNKEN 636, 637, 652  
TELETECH 644  
TENSAI 640, 641  
THOMSON 636, 651, 652, 663  
THORN 631, 607, 642, 645, 648  
TOMASHI 618  
TOSHIBA 605, 602, 626, 621, 653  
TOWADA 642  
ULTRAVOX 632, 642, 649  
UNIVERSUM 631, 607, 638, 642, 645, 646, 654, 655  
VESTEL 607  
VICTOR 613  
VOXSON 631  
WALTHAM 643  
WATSON 607  
WATT RADIO 632, 642, 649  
WHITE  
WESTINGHOUSE 607  
YOKO 607, 642, 646  
ZENITH 603, 620  
PIONEER 600, 631, 632, 607, 636, 642, 651  
90  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
Dolby Digital  
Glossary  
1
Analog audio  
An electrical signal that directly represents  
sound. Compare this to digital audio which  
can be an electrical signal, but is an indirect  
representation of sound. See also Digital  
audio.  
Using a maximum of 5.1 channels of audio,  
this high quality surround system is used in  
many of the finer movie theaters around the  
world.  
The on-screen display shows which channels  
are active, for example showing 3/2.1. The 3  
being the two front channels and the center  
channel; the 2 being the surround channels,  
and the .1 being the LFE channel.  
Aspect ratio  
The width of a TV screen relative to its height.  
Conventional TVs are 4:3 (in other words, the  
screen is almost square); widescreen models  
are 16:9 (the screen is almost twice as wide as  
it is high).  
Dolby Pro Logic / Pro Logic II  
Bonus Group (DVD-Audio only)  
An ‘extra’ group on some DVD-Audio discs  
that requires a key number to access. See  
also Bonus Group on page 69.  
A matrix decoding system that extracts 4.1  
(Dolby Pro Logic) or 5.1 (Dolby Pro Logic II)  
channel surround sound from a two channel  
source.  
Browsable pictures (DVD-Audio only)  
A feature of some DVD-Audio discs in which  
the user can browse still pictures recorded on  
the disc as the audio is played. See also Slide-  
show.  
DTS  
R
Digital audio  
DTS stands for Digital Theater Systems. DTS  
is a surround system different from Dolby  
Digital that has become a popular surround  
sound format for movies.  
An indirect representation of sound by  
numbers. During recording, the sound is  
measured at discrete intervals (44,100 times a  
second for CD audio) by an analog-to-digital  
converter, generating a stream of numbers.  
On playback, a digital-to-analog converter  
generates an analog signal based on these  
numbers. See also Sampling frequency and  
Analog audio.  
Dynamic range  
The difference between the quietest and  
loudest sounds possible in an audio signal  
(without distorting or getting lost in noise).  
Dolby Digital and DTS soundtracks are  
capable of a very wide dynamic range, deliv-  
ering dramatic cinema-like effects.  
91  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
EXIF (Exchangeable Image File)  
A file format developed by Fuji Photo Film for  
digital still cameras. Digital cameras from  
various manuafcturers use this compressed  
file format which carries date, time and  
thumbnail information, as well as the picture  
data.  
MPEG video  
The video format used for Video CDs and  
DVDs. Video CD uses the older MPEG-1 stan-  
dard, while DVD uses the newer and much  
better quality MPEG-2 standard.  
PBC (PlayBack Control) (Video CD/Super  
VCD only)  
A system of navigating a Video CD/Super VCD  
through on-screen menus recorded onto the  
disc. Especially good for discs that you would  
normally not watch from beginning to end all  
at once—karaoke discs, for example.  
File extension  
A tag added to the end of a filename to indi-  
cate the type of file. For example, “.mp3” indi-  
cates an MP3 file.  
ISO 9660 format  
International standard for the volume and file  
structure of CD-ROM discs.  
PCM (Pulse Code Modulation)  
The most common system of encoding digital  
audio, found on CDs and DAT. Excellent  
quality, but requires a lot of data compared to  
formats such as Dolby Digital and MPEG  
audio. See also Digital audio.  
JPEG  
A file format used for still images, such as  
photographs and illustrations. JPEG files are  
identified by the file extension “.jpg” or “.JPG”.  
Most digital cameras use this format.  
Regions (DVD-Video only)  
These associate discs and players with partic-  
ular areas of the world. This system will only  
play discs that have compatible region codes.  
You can find the region code of your system  
by looking on the rear panel. Some discs are  
compatible with more than one region (or all  
regions).  
MP3  
MP3 (MPEG1 audio layer 3) is a compressed  
audio file format. Files are recognized by their  
file extension “.mp3” or “.MP3”.  
MLP / Packed PCM (DVD-Audio only)  
A lossless compression system that enables  
more PCM audio to be stored on a DVD-  
Audio disc than would otherwise be possible.  
S1 S-video output  
This S-video signal format includes aspect  
ratio information (4:3 or 16:9) within the video  
signal.  
MPEG audio  
An audio format used on Video CDs and some  
DVD discs. This system can convert MPEG  
audio to PCM format for wider compatibility  
with digital recorders and AV amplifiers. See  
also PCM (Pulse Code Modulation).  
S2 S-video output  
S2 is an enhanced version of S-video which, in  
addition to aspect ratio information, contains  
letterbox / pan & scan information.  
Widescreen TVs which are compatible with  
S2 S-video automatically switch to the  
appropriate mode according to the signal.  
92  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
Sampling frequency  
The rate at which sound is measured to be  
turned into digital audio data. The higher the  
rate, the better the sound quality, but the  
more digital information is generated. Stan-  
dard CD audio has a sampling frequency of  
44.1kHz, which means 44,100 samples  
(measurements) per second. See also Digital  
audio.  
Slide show (DVD, Video CD/Super VCD)  
A feature of some DVD discs and Video-CD/  
Super VCDs in which still pictures recorded  
on the disc cycle automatically as the audio is  
played. See also Browsable pictures.  
Super Audio CD (SACD)  
Super Audio CD is a high quality audio disc  
format that can accomodate high sampling  
rate stereo and multi-channel audio, as well  
as conventional CD audio all on the same  
disc.  
93  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Additional information  
Accessories  
Specifications  
Operating Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Setup guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Display unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Remote control unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Power cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2  
Video Cord (yellow plugs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Display cable (gray plugs). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Control cable A (blue plugs). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Control cable B (black plugs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
FM antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
AM loop antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Dry cell batteries (AA/R6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2  
Speaker cords (5 m) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3  
Speaker cords (10 m) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2  
Non-skid pads (center speaker)  
(S-DV700ST only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3  
Non-skid pads (subwoofer). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
Speaker stands (front/surround speakers) . . . 4  
Speaker stand (center speaker)  
(S-DV900ST only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Large screw (S-DV900ST only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
Medium screw (S-DV900ST only) . . . . . . . . . . . 2  
Small screw (S-DV900ST only) . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Cover plate (S-DV900ST only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
Amplifier Section  
Continuous Power (RMS) . . . . . 75 W / channel  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (1 kHz, THD 10%, 6 )  
Disc section  
Digital audio  
characteristics . . . . . . . . DVD fs: 96 kHz, 24-bit  
Type . . . . . . DVD system, Video CD system and  
Compact Disc digital audio system  
Frequency response  
48 kHz sampling . . . . . . . . . . 4 Hz – 22 kHz  
96 kHz sampling . . . . . . . . . . 4 Hz – 44 kHz  
192 kHz sampling . . . . . . . . . 4 Hz – 88 kHz  
S/N ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108dB  
Dynamic range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95dB  
Total harmonic distortion. . . . . . . . . . . . 0.005 %  
Wow and Flutter . . . . . . . Limit of measurement  
(
0.001 % W.PEAK) or less (JEITA)  
FM tuner section  
Frequency Range . . . . . . . . . . . . .87.5 - 108MHz  
Antenna. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 , unbalanced  
Satellite Speaker System  
(S-DV700ST)  
Type Sealed, antimagnetic  
AM tuner section  
Frequency Range  
Speaker. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8.7 cm (cone type)  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5.2 cm (cone type)  
Nominal impedence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Ω  
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 – 20,000 Hz  
Max. input. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 W (JEITA)  
Front / Surround speakers  
Dimensions . . . . 110 (W) x 59 (D) x 284 (H) cm  
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg  
Center speaker  
. . . . . . . . . . . .531 kHz to 1,602 kHz (9 kHz step)  
. . . . . . . . . . .530 kHz to 1,700 kHz (10 kHz step)  
Antenna. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Loop antenna  
Miscellaneous  
Power Requirements  
. . AC 110–120 V/220–230 V/240 V, 50/60 Hz  
Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 W  
Power Consumption  
Dimensions . . . . 284 (W) x 59 (D) x 110 (H) cm  
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg  
in standby mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.55 W  
Dimensions:  
DVD/CD Tuner . 360 (W) x 74 (H) x 270 (D) mm  
Display Unit. . . . . 274 (W) x 44 (H) x 35 (D) mm  
Weight:  
DVD/CD Tuner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.2 kg  
Display Unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0.2 kg  
94  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
12  
Satellite Speaker System  
(S-DV900ST)  
Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flat panel type bookshelf  
Speaker  
• Specifications and design subject to  
possible modification without notice, due  
to improvements.  
Exciter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 cm exciter x 3  
Tweeter . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm (semi-dome type)  
Nominal impedence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Ω  
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 – 35,000 Hz  
Max. input. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 W (JEITA)  
Front / Surround speakers  
Dimensions . . . . 120 (W) x 30 (D) x 450 (H) cm  
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.9 kg  
Center speaker  
This product includes FontAvenue®  
fonts licenced by NEC corporation.  
FontAvenue is a registered trademark  
of NEC Corporation.  
Dimensions . . . . 420 (W) x 32 (D) x 120 (H) cm  
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.9 kg  
The S-DV900ST satellite speakers are flat-panel-  
type units that use NXT® speaker technology.  
These slim style speakers allow for easy  
installation anywhere.  
NXT and the  
logo are registered  
trademarks of New Transducers Limited.  
Powered subwoofer  
(S-DV700SW/S-DV900SW)  
Type. . . . . . Bass reflex floor type, antimagnetic  
Speaker. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 cm (cone type)  
Nominal impedence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Ω  
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 – 2,300 Hz  
Max. input. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 W (JEITA)  
Dimensions . . . 192 (W) x 436 (D) x 395 (H) cm  
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.5 kg  
95  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CAUTION  
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK  
DO NOT OPEN  
5 cm  
28 cm  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
感謝惠購先鋒產品。  
請通讀使用說明書以了解本型號的正確操作方法。通讀完畢後,請妥善保存,以備日後參考。  
目錄  
01 開始使用之前  
以立體聲模式收聽 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31  
用耳機收聽  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32  
功能 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
家庭影院使用說明  
使用高級環繞聲效果  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32  
調節高級環繞聲效果等級 . . . . . . . . . . . .33  
增強對話  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9  
一般碟片兼容性  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9  
CD-R/RW 兼容. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
兼容性  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33  
用虛擬後置環繞聲揚聲器收聽 . . . . . . . . . .34  
DVD-R/RW  
PC 製作碟片的兼容性 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
. . . . . . . . . . . . .34  
使用安靜和午夜聽音模式  
調節低音和高音  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35  
壓縮音頻兼容性  
文件兼容性  
增強低音等級 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36  
JPEG  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11  
靜音  
02 控制按鈕和顯示  
前面板 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
播放碟片  
05  
介紹  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37  
使用碟片導向瀏覽碟片內容. . . . . . . . . . . .37  
掃描碟片  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
顯示幕裝置  
顯示幕  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38  
慢動作播放  
遙控器 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39  
逐幀前進/逐幀倒退 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39  
循環播放碟片上的某一段  
03  
開機和設置  
開始使用  
. . . . . . . . . . . . .40  
使用重複播放 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40  
OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18  
設置時鐘  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19  
使用  
使用顯示幕  
設置遙控器以控制電視機. . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
使用房間設置  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41  
使用隨機播放 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42  
使用  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
使用螢幕顯示. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42  
創建編序列表  
播放碟片  
基本播放控制按鈕  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43  
使用 OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
恢復和最終記憶 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
使用本機顯示幕  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46  
碟片選單  
DVD  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
選單  
清除編序列表  
超級  
VCD/  
VCD  
PBC  
. . . . . . . . . 26  
搜索碟片 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47  
播放 唱碟的 “附送類”  
收聽收音機. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
改善不良的 接收  
DVD  
. . . . . . . . . . .47  
FM  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
收聽預設電臺. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29  
收聽其他播放源  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
切換字幕 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47  
記憶電臺  
切換  
切換  
影碟伴音語言  
DVD  
DVD  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .48  
唱碟的音頻聲道  
. . . . . . . . . . . .48  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29  
切換 VCD 超級 VCD 的音頻聲道 . . . . . .48  
放大屏幕畫面  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48  
04 家庭影院的聲效  
自動聽音模式. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30  
切換視角  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49  
用環繞聲進行收聽  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30  
音樂設定  
杜比  
Pro Logic II  
. . . . . . . . . . 31  
5
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Options  
Parental Lock  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67  
(選項)  
顯示碟片資訊  
碟片資訊  
(家長鎖定)  
. . . . . . . . . .67  
OSD  
顯示幕資訊 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51  
Bonus Group (附送類). . . . . . . . . . . .69  
(自動碟片選單)  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
. . . .70  
(分組播放)  
. . . . . . . .70  
06  
播放  
JPEG  
碟片  
觀看  
JPEG  
DVD Playback Mode DVD  
70  
播放模式)  
碟片  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52  
播放)  
. . . . . . .71  
SACD Playback SACD  
使用  
碟片導向和圖片瀏覽器  
JPEG  
放大屏幕畫面  
. . . . . . 52  
PhotoViewer (圖片瀏覽器) . . . . . . . .71  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53  
11  
其它連接  
連接外接天線  
連接輔助設備  
07  
使用定時器  
設置喚醒定時器  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54  
開啟/關閉喚醒定時器 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
降低電視機和線路信號電平 . . . . . . . . . .73  
錄音模式  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
設置睡眠定時器  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74  
使用 視頻輸出端進行連接  
S
. . . . . . . . . . . .74  
環繞聲設定  
08  
設定環繞聲  
使用設備視頻輸出進行連. . . . . . . . . . . .75  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57  
系統設定選單選項 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57  
設置聲道等級  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
12  
附加資訊  
關閉演示  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76  
童鎖  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76  
視頻調節  
選單  
(Video Adjust)  
09  
視頻調節  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76  
改變時鐘格式  
改變頻率等級  
(Video Adjust) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
創建您自己的預設項 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
設置電視制式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77  
制電視機 ( )上觀看  
PAL  
MOD.PAL  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77  
重置本系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77  
10  
初始設置  
使用初始設置  
(Initial Settings)  
選單  
選單  
. . . . 62  
節目  
NTSC  
(Initial Settings)  
(數位音頻模  
Digital Audio Mode Settings  
調節顯示幕亮度  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
式設定)  
使用和保護碟片  
(杜比數位輸出)  
Dolby Digital Out  
. . 62  
標題,章和曲目 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78  
影碟區域  
DTS Out DTS 輸出) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
DVD  
拿取碟片 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78  
(線性  
輸出)  
PCM . . . 63  
Linear PCM Out  
(視頻輸出設置)  
63  
Video Output settings  
存儲碟片  
不可使用的碟片  
TV Screen TV 屏幕. . . . . . . . . . . . . 63  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79  
本系統正確安裝和維護 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
安裝提示  
(分量輸出)  
Component Out  
. . . . . . . 64  
S
視頻輸出)  
. . . . . . . . . 65  
S-Video Out  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
清潔拾取頭  
Language settings (語言設置) . . . . . . 65  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
關於結露問題 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
搬移本機  
(伴音語言)  
. . . . . . . 65  
Audio Language  
(字幕語言)  
Subtitle Language  
. . . . . 65  
選單語言)  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
電源線注意事項  
DVD Menu Language DVD  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81  
66  
Subtitle Display (字幕顯示) . . . . . . . 66  
(顯示設置)  
Display settings  
OSD Language OSD  
On Screen Display  
. . . . . . . . 66  
語言)  
. . . . . . . 66  
. . . . . 66  
(螢幕顯示)  
(角度指示器)  
Angle Indicator  
. . . . . . 67  
6
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
故障排除  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
播放機  
DVD/CD/VCD  
MP3/JPEG  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83  
碟片  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85  
調諧器  
錯誤訊息  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85  
屏幕尺寸和碟片格式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87  
寬屏電視機用戶  
標準電視機用戶  
使用語言代碼列表選擇語. . . . . . . . . . . 87  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88  
語言代碼列表  
國家 地區 代碼列表  
(
)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88  
預設代碼列表. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89  
術語  
規格  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94  
7
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
01  
開始使用之前  
1 章  
開始使用之前  
圖像放大  
功能  
在播DVDVCDVCD能夠放大  
圖像的任一部分仔細觀看,最大可放大到 4  
倍。請參見48頁放大屏幕畫面。  
DVD  
SACD  
兼容  
使您可體DVD碟和超CDSACD)  
唱碟和  
超凡的高品質音頻性能。  
MP3  
兼容  
24bit/192kHz DAC使用意味著本播放  
機與高取樣率的碟片完全兼而在動態範  
圍、電平解析和高頻細節方面能夠提供極佳  
的音質。  
本播放機可兼容含有 MP3 音頻曲目的 CD-R、  
CD-RWCD-ROM片。請參見10壓縮  
音頻兼容性。  
圖形化螢幕顯示  
圖形化螢幕顯示讓您能夠十分輕鬆地設置和  
使用您DVD庭影院系統。  
采用杜比數比專業邏比專業邏  
*1  
*2  
II  
DTS  
軟體的卓越音頻性能  
節能設計  
本系統處於待機模式時的設計功耗0.55 W。  
內置式杜比數位DTS解碼器讓您能夠享受到  
帶杜比數位DTSDVD片所具有的真  
正獨立多聲道家庭影院聲音效果。  
*1 經杜比實驗室授權生產DolbyPro  
Logic”及D誌是杜比實驗室的商標。  
杜比專業邏輯和杜比專業邏II碼方式通  
過環繞聲播雙聲道播放源資料增添了極  
大的震撼力。  
*2 “DTS”和“DTS Digital Surround數  
碼影院系統公Digital Theater  
Systems,Inc.)的註冊商標。  
環繞聲音效的簡易房間設置  
通過房間設置功使用兩個步驟即可設置  
基本的環繞聲音知本機您聽音房間的大  
小以及您的聽音位置統即能自動配置環  
繞聲音效。  
8
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
01  
開始使用之前  
家庭影院使用說明  
一般碟片兼容性  
本機設計為可與帶有以下一個或幾個標誌的  
您可能習慣於使用立體聲設備來收聽音樂而  
從來沒有用過家庭影院系者可以在您收  
聽曲目時向您提供更多的可選項繞  
。  
軟體兼容︰  
家庭影院是指利用多音軌來創造一種環繞聲  
您感到自己正處於動作場景或者音樂  
會的中心位源於家庭影院系統的環繞聲  
不僅取決於您在房間內所安放的揚聲器情,  
還取決於播放源以及系統的聲音設置。  
由於其尺寸,質量以及使用便捷的特點,DVD  
影碟已成為家庭影院的基本播放源資料。視  
DVD定,您可以從一張碟片中獲得多6種  
不同的音所有音軌將被發送到您系統的  
各個揚聲器中。這就是環繞聲效果的創造方  
式,可以給您以身臨其境的感受。  
本機將根據您的揚聲器設置情動對杜比  
DTS杜比環DVD碟進行解碼。在  
大多數情況將無需改變即可獲得逼真的  
環繞聲,但在30 家庭影院的聲效”中  
將對其他效果進行說如用多聲道環繞聲  
CD。  
KODAK Picture CD  
Fuji Photo Film司的商標。  
本播放機支IECVCDCD  
標準相VCD提供卓越的畫並可  
進行兩條立體聲音軌的錄VCD支持  
寬螢幕尺寸。  
VIDEO  
CD  
其他格包括但不限於下列格式)不能在  
本機上播放︰  
*
DVD-RAM / DVD-ROM / CD-ROM  
* 除那些含有MP3或JPEG的以參見壓縮  
音頻兼容性JPEG件兼容性。  
9
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
01  
開始使用之前  
使用 DVD 錄製機,CD 錄製機或個人電腦錄製  
DVD-R/RWCD-R/RWCDVCD)  
可能不能在本機上播放。其原因可能有眾多,  
包括但不限於:使用的碟片類型;錄製類型;  
碟片或播放機拾取鏡頭的損壞,塵垢或結露。  
有關專用軟體和格式的注意事項,請參見下  
文。  
製作碟片的兼容性  
PC  
如果您用個人電腦錄製碟片,即使該碟片  
是以前述兼容格式”錄製的,也可能  
由於製作碟片的應用程式的設置問題而無  
法在本機上播放。遇到此類情況請向軟體  
發行商咨詢詳情。  
檢查DVD-R/RW或CD-R/RW軟體碟片包裝,  
以獲得更多的有關兼容方面的資訊。  
CD-R/RW  
兼容性  
本機能夠播放CD唱碟VCD格式錄製的  
CD-RCD-RW片,或將其作為含MP3  
JPEG 文件CD-ROM行播放。但是,  
任何其他內容都會使碟片無法播放或使輸  
出產生噪音/失真。  
壓縮音頻兼容性  
本機能夠播放取樣率為3244.1或48kHz且  
其中所含文件以 MPEG-1頻層 3MP3)  
格式保存CD-ROM、CD-R和CD-RW。  
不兼容的文件將不能播會顯示  
Can't  
(無法播放此格式)的  
play this format  
本機無法錄CD-RCD-RW片。  
顯示幕上顯“  
(不播  
No Play  
本機能夠播放作為CD唱碟錄製的未經最終  
完成CD-R/RW片,但無法顯示其完整  
的目播放時間等。  
〕。  
我們推薦採用固定位元率的MP3文變  
位元VBR)的 MP3 文件能夠被播放,  
但播放時間可能無法正確顯示。  
兼容性  
DVD-R/RW  
本機能夠播放以DVD影碟格式錄製並用DVD  
用於編MP3CD-ROM須符ISO  
9660 Level 1或2CD 物理格式︰模  
1,模式2 XA Form 1。本播放機同時兼  
RomeoJoliet件系統。  
錄製機最終完成DVD-R/RW片。  
本機能夠播放用視頻錄製(VR)格式錄製  
DVD-RW片。  
請使用CD-R或CD-RW碟片錄製您的文。碟  
片必須最終完即片段必須結束便  
能在本機上播放。本播放機不兼容多片段  
碟片。本機只識別多片段碟片的1片  
段。  
VR式的DVD-RW示幕將顯  
DVD-RW。  
播放由DVD製機編輯VR格式DVD-RW  
碟片時,在編輯點處螢幕可能暫時變黑,  
/者您可能會看見編輯點位置前面  
的畫面。  
本播放機僅播放文件擴展名為.mp3或.MP3  
的曲目。  
本機無法錄DVD-R/RW片。  
命名MP3文件加上相應的文件擴展名  
(.mp3件根據文件擴展名播放了  
防止噪聲和故障,請勿對其他種類的文件  
使用這些擴展名。  
本播放機無法播放未最終完成的DVD-R/RW  
碟片。  
10  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
01  
開始使用之前  
本播放機最多可識999MP3/  
JPEG)499文件夾。如果碟片中的文  
件或文件夾數超過這個限制,則最多只能  
播放限制數目內的文件或文件夾。文件和  
文件夾以字母順序讀/示。請注意,  
如果文件結構較為複雜,您可能不能讀取  
/放碟片上的所有文件。  
文件夾和曲目名不包括文件擴展名)  
將被顯示。  
MP3件編碼可有許多不同的錄製位元  
率。機設計可與它們全部兼。以  
128Kbps碼的音頻接近常規CD質。  
本播放機能夠播放低位元率的文件,但請  
注意,在低位元率時音質將明顯下降。  
文件兼容性  
JPEG  
本機支持最高為8萬像素的基線JPEG和  
EXIF 2.1* 靜像文件(最大垂直和水平分  
辨率5120 像素* 數位相機所用文  
件格式)  
用於編JPEG件的CD-ROM必須符ISO  
9660 Level 1 2CD理格式︰模  
12 XA Form 1播放機同時兼  
容RomeoJoliet 文件系統。  
本播放機只播放文件擴展名為.jpg或.JPG  
的文件。  
11  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
02  
控制按鈕和顯示  
2 章  
控制按鈕和顯示  
前面板  
1
2
3
TIMER  
STANDBY/ON  
OPEN/CLOSE  
4
6
7
5
8
5 STANDBY/ON  
按該按鈕開啟系統或將其切換至待機狀態。  
1 VOLUME 按鈕  
用於調節音量。  
2
按該按鈕停止播放。  
碟片托盤  
6
7
OPEN/CLOSE  
3
按該按鈕將打開/關閉碟片托盤。  
DVD/CD  
按該按鈕切換至  
開始/暫停/恢復播放。  
定時器指示器  
功能。也可以用於  
插孔  
8 PHONES  
耳機插孔。  
4
在設置好喚醒定時器後亮(第54)。  
顯示幕裝置  
9
10  
遙感窗  
顯示幕  
10  
9
詳情請參見13頁顯示幕。  
12  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
02  
控制按鈕和顯示  
顯示幕  
3
5
1
2
4
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13  
14  
MIDNIGHT QUIET  
PGM RPT-1  
RDM  
V.PART  
ATT  
REC MODE  
PRO LOGIC  
DIGITAL  
ADV.SURR.  
PRGSVE  
kHz  
MHz  
20  
19  
18 17 16 15  
8
V.PART  
當播DVD片的視頻部分時亮起。  
ATT  
調諧器指示器  
1
9
接收廣播時亮起。  
啟動輸入衰減器以進行當前所選的模擬輸入  
時亮(第73)。  
以自動立體聲模式接收立體聲FM廣播時亮  
起。  
10 REC MODE  
開啟錄製模式時亮(第74)。  
FM聲道接收被選定時亮起。  
定時器指示器  
11  
2
播放碟片時亮起。  
MIDNIGHT  
午夜模式被選定時亮(第34)。  
設置好喚醒定時器後亮(第54)。  
啟動睡眠定時器時亮( 第56 )。  
3
4
QUIET  
安靜模式被選定時亮(第34)。  
PGM  
編序列表被編序時亮(第43)。  
12 2 PRO LOGIC II  
在杜PRO LOGIC碼期間亮起 (30)。  
5
13 2DIGITAL  
在播放杜比數位播放源期間亮(第30)。  
6
RPT  
RPT-1  
RPT  
( 第40 )。  
在重複播放期間  
亮起。在單曲重複播放  
期間  
RPT-1  
RDM  
在隨機播放期間亮( 第42 )。  
7
13  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
02  
控制按鈕和顯示  
揚聲器指示器  
14  
這些指示器表示正用於輸出當前播放源的揚  
聲器。下圖表示若干顯示實例。  
5.1道環繞聲  
立體2.1道)  
帶中央聲道對話增強3.1道  
聲音  
啟動了虛擬後置環繞聲模式5.1  
聲道環繞聲  
15 PRGSVE  
逐行掃描視頻輸出被選定時亮(第64)。  
16 ADV.SURR.  
一種高級環繞聲聽音模式被選定時亮起(第32  
頁)。  
17 DTS  
在播DTS放源期間亮(第30)。  
18 kHz / MHz  
表明字符顯示幕中所顯示的頻率單(  
kHz  
於AM,  
FM。  
MHz  
19 字符顯示幕  
20  
DVD碟片上出現多視角場景時亮(第49)。  
14  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
02  
控制按鈕和顯示  
3
DISPLAY  
遙控器  
按該按鈕顯示/改變螢幕顯示的碟片資(第  
49)。  
STANDBY/ON  
FM/AM  
1
2
CD  
L1/L2  
LINE  
4
碟片播放控制按鈕  
DVD  
TUNER  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN/CLOSE  
3
4
5
6
7
11  
按該按鈕開始或恢復播放。  
ꢆ/ꢇ  
12  
13  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
用於進行向後慢幀倒退和倒退掃。  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ꢉ/ꢊ  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
用於進行向前慢放,逐幀前進以及向前掃  
描。  
8
9
14  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
按該按鈕暫停播次按重新開始播。  
10  
15  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
按該按鈕停止播放。  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
5
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
HOME  
MENU  
按該按鈕將跳至當前章/曲目的開始後  
跳至前一章/曲目。  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
SETUP  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
4
6
DVD MENU  
22  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
CLOCK  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
8
9
如果裝入了一張 VR 格式的 DVD-RW,CD,VCD  
VCD,MP3JPEG按該按鈕則顯  
DVD片選單或碟片導航器。  
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
光標按鈕,  
和調諧按鈕  
ENTER  
7
光標按鈕  
使用光標按鈕(ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ)導向螢幕顯  
示和選單。  
將  
MAIN/SUB 開關切換SUB 獲得。  
ENTER  
1
STANDBY/ON  
按該按鈕選擇某一選者執行某一命  
令。  
按該按鈕開啟系統或切換至待機狀態。  
TUNE +/–  
功能選擇按鈕  
2
按這些的播〔  
用於調諧收音機。  
DVD  
, , 〕  
(CD) TUNER TV LINE  
15  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
02  
控制按鈕和顯示  
ST +/–  
SURROUND  
收聽收音機時用於選擇預設的電臺。  
用於選擇環繞聲模(第30 )。  
8
9
MUTE  
ADVANCED  
按該按鈕使各揚聲器和耳機中的所有聲音  
再按則取消靜音)(36)。  
用於選擇高級環繞(第32 )。  
(副功能)  
MASTER VOLUME  
BASS MODE  
用於調節音量。  
用於選擇低音模( 第35)。  
(第20頁)  
10 TV CONTROL  
DIALOGUE  
用於選擇對話模( 第33)。  
按該按鈕打開電視機或切換至待機狀態。  
VIRTUAL SB  
INPUT  
按該按鈕開啟/關閉虛擬後置環繞聲揚聲  
器效(第34 )。  
按該按鈕切換至電視機輸入。  
CH +/–  
16 DVD/CD  
按鈕  
用於選擇電視機頻道。  
(主功能)  
VOL +/–  
AUDIO  
用於調節電視機的音量。  
按該按鈕選擇音頻聲道或伴音語(第47  
)。  
11 OPEN/CLOSE  
按該按鈕打開/關閉碟片托盤。  
SUBTITLE  
按該按鈕顯示/改DVD幕顯(第47  
)。  
12 ꢍ  
按該按鈕跳至下一章/曲目。  
ANGLE  
13 RETURN  
按該按鈕在進DVD視角場景播放期間  
改變攝像機視(第49 )。  
按該按鈕返回前一選單畫面。  
14 SOUND  
(副功能)  
按該按鈕進入聲音選您可以從中調DSP  
效果等級,低音和高音等選項。  
PROGRAM  
用於編序/播放編序列(第43 )。  
15  
環繞聲模式/聲音增強按鈕  
(主功能)  
REPEAT  
用於選擇重複播放模( 第40)。  
AUTO  
RANDOM  
用於選擇隨機播放模( 第42)。  
按該按鈕為當前播放源選擇預設解碼方式  
(第30)。  
16  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
02  
控制按鈕和顯示  
(副功能)  
(副功能)  
17  
ZOOM  
FOLDER –  
按該按鈕改變畫面縮放比(第48)。  
按該按鈕跳至前一文件夾。  
TOP MENU  
FOLDER +  
用於顯示播放位置處DVD片的頂層選  
這可能和按DVD MENU 的效果相  
按該按鈕跳至後一文件夾。  
21 MAIN / SUB  
。  
改變至  
可進入遙控器上印製呈  
SUB  
MAIN  
HOME MENU  
綠色的功能。  
按該按鈕顯或退出)初始設置,播放  
模式功能等項目的螢幕顯示選單。  
(主功能)  
ROOM SETUP  
(副功能)  
18  
19  
20  
按該按鈕開始房間設( 第20 )。  
SYSTEM SETUP  
22  
(主功能)  
用於進種系環繞置(第57頁)。  
數字按鈕  
TEST TONE  
使用數字按鈕直接選擇碟片中的標題章  
用於輸出測試音(設定揚聲器用( 59  
頁)。  
曲目。  
CH LEVEL  
用於調節揚聲器等( 第59)。  
(副功能)  
DIMMER  
按該按鈕使顯示幕變暗或變亮。  
QUIET/MIDNIGHT  
用於選擇安靜模式和午夜模式(34)。  
TIMER/CLOCK  
按該按鈕顯示時鐘或進入定時器選單(第  
1954 頁。  
(主功能)  
CLR  
按該按鈕清除輸入。  
ENTER  
選擇選單選項等和上文第  
條中的  
7
按鈕效果完全一樣。  
ENTER  
17  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
3 章  
開始使用  
您應看到顯示歡迎畫面。  
開機和設置  
在確認所有設備連接正確可準備開機首  
先需確認您使用的電視機種類,標準或寬屏。  
Welcome to Pioneer DVD!  
Thank you for purchasing this Pioneer DVD player.  
在此之您可為您的房間設置環繞並可  
設置時鐘以便使用定時器功能。  
Before using, please take a little time  
to setup your DVD player  
Put the batteries into the remote control  
Next, press the [ENTER] button on the remote control  
and start the Let's Get Started Menu  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
Next  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
2
3
ENTER  
移至下一畫面。  
根據您的電視機種類用  
(左/右  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
光標)按鈕選擇 “  
)”  
Standard size screen  
標準尺寸屏幕 ( 然後按  
Wide Screen 16:9  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
〔寬屏 (  
16:9  
或 “  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
4:3 4:3  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
ENTER  
如果無法確定如何選擇,請同時參見第 87 頁  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
屏幕尺寸和碟片格式。  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
Let's Get Started Menu  
What kind of TV do you have?  
1
STANDBY/ON(在遙控器或前面板  
上)打開系統。  
Use the  
/
cursor buttons  
to choose, then press [ENTER]  
同時請確認電視機已打開且視頻輸出已連至  
本系統。  
Wide screen (16:9)  
Standard size screen (4:3)  
18  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
再次按  
結束設置。  
ENTER  
4
設置時鐘  
設置時鐘將使您能夠使用定時器功能。  
Let's Get Started Menu  
STANDBY/ON  
Setup complete  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
If you're finished setting up,  
choose [Complete],  
DVD  
TV  
to start again choose [Back]  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
Complete  
Back  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
如果您要返回並改變先前進行的設置,請  
使用 (右光標)按鈕選擇  
ENTER  
後再按  
Back  
MUTE  
SOUND  
ENTER  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
使(  
DVD/CD  
按鈕將系  
OPEN/CLOSE  
或  
TUNER  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
統從待機狀態切換至開啟狀態。  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
1
2
TIMER/CLOCK  
如果您在調節時鐘但非初次進行設置,請  
再次按  
TIMER/CLOCK  
如果顯示幕中尚未出現 “Clock ADJ?,  
請按 (左光標或右光標)直至您看  
見該資訊為止。  
3
4
5
ENTER  
使用  
(上/下光標)按鈕設定小。  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
ENTER  
19  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
使用  
(上/下光標)按鈕設定分。  
6
7
ꢀ/ꢁ  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
ENTER 進行確認。  
TV CONTROL  
顯示幕閃爍表示時鐘已被設定。  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
AUTO  
VIRTUAL SB  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
任何時候TIMER/CLOCK 將顯示時鐘。  
按鈕  
功能  
打開電視機或切換至待機狀。  
改變電視機頻道。  
CH +/–  
VOL +/–  
INPUT  
如果從牆面插座上拔出系統的插頭或發生  
停電,您將需要重新設定時鐘。  
調節音量。  
在內置式電視調諧器和外部視  
頻播放源之間切換電視機輸。  
設置遙控器以控制電視機  
您可以通過使用  
按鈕對隨機提  
TV CONTROL  
供的遙控器進行設置以控制電視機。  
預設狀態為先鋒電視機。  
開啟電視機。  
1
2
在第 89 頁上的預設代碼列表中找出電視  
使用房間設置  
機的製造商名稱。  
在使用您的系統來欣賞環繞聲播放之議  
您花幾分鐘時間來使用房間設為您的房  
間營造良好的環繞不失為一個快捷的方  
法。  
各製造商之後是一個或多個三位數代些  
代碼會將您的電視機種類資訊傳達至遙控器。  
如果您的電視機製造商名稱沒有出現在表中,  
您將無法設置該遙控器控制電視機。  
根據您的主要收聽位置到環繞聲揚聲器的距  
離,可在 (小中)或 (大)房間  
將遙控器對著電視機,按住  
然  
3
後輸入您電視機的三位數代碼。  
CLR  
S
M
L
中進行選後根據座位到前置揚聲器和環  
繞聲揚聲器的相對位置,選擇 (前方,  
遙控器向電視機發射開/關信果您已輸  
入了正確代碼,則電視機應該關閉。  
Fwd  
(後方。  
Back  
(中間)或者  
Mid  
如果您的電視機沒有關使用列表中的下  
一代碼重複該步驟,直至您的電視機成功關  
旦設置完畢接著就可使用如下所示  
的各個電視機控制按鈕。  
20  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
如果系統尚未開啟,請按  
1
STANDBY/  
使用螢幕顯示  
開啟。  
ON  
為了方便使機大量使用圖形化螢幕顯示  
(OSD您應該熟悉該工作方因為當您設  
置播放使用某些播放功能(如編序播放)  
以及對音頻和視頻進行更高級的設定需  
要用到它們。  
2
ROOM SETUP。  
如果您以前已設置好房間類型和座位位  
置,顯示幕將顯示當前房間設置。  
3
4
ENTER  
所有畫面基本上都以相同的方法導航︰用光  
使用  
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇房間  
標按( , , , 變高亮項目,  
ꢀ ꢁ ꢂ ꢃ  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
ENTER 選定。  
類型,然後按  
ENTER  
根據您的房間大小選擇以下之一:  
S —小於普通房間  
M —普通房間  
在本說明書中”的意思是用光標  
按鈕高亮顯示一個項目,再按  
L  
—大於普通房間  
ENTER  
使用  
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇座位  
5
ꢀ/ꢁ  
設置,然後按  
ENTER  
根據您的主要收聽位置選擇以下之一:  
—與環繞聲揚聲器相果您更靠  
Fwd  
近前置揚聲器  
Mid —如果您到環繞聲揚聲器的距離和到  
前置揚聲器的距離相同  
Back —與前置揚聲器相果您更靠近  
環繞聲揚聲器  
房間設置自動設置聲道等級和揚聲器距  
離。如果您已經手動設置了聲道等級(請  
參見第 59 頁)或揚聲器距請參見第  
58則在初次按下 ROOM SETUP 按  
鈕後將看到顯示幕中出Room Set?。  
使用房間設置功能將覆蓋所有以前設置的  
聲道等級和揚聲器距離。  
有關環繞聲設定的詳細說參見57  
設定環繞聲。  
21  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
每個 OSD面底部的按鈕指南顯示在該畫  
面中所需用到的按鈕。  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
ENTER  
播放碟片  
MUTE  
SOUND  
此處說明的是播DVD,CDSACD,VCD超  
VCDMP3片的基本播放控制功多  
的功能將在5 詳述。  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
明書中DVD”表有種類的  
DVD碟DVD影DVD唱碟或DVD-R/RW。  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
如果播放機尚未打請按  
SYSTEM  
1
STANDBY/  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
打開播放機。  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
ON  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
如果您播放的DVDVCDVCD,同時  
也請打開您的電視確認電視機已設定到  
正確的視頻輸入上。  
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
打開碟片托盤。  
2
3
OPEN/CLOSE  
裝入碟片。  
按鈕  
功能  
裝入碟片時應使碟片的標籤面向碟片托  
盤導軌對準碟如果您裝入的是一張雙面  
DVD片,請將欲播放的一面向下。  
HOME  
MENU  
顯示/退出螢幕顯示  
ꢂꢀꢁꢃ  
改變高亮選單項目  
ENTER  
選定高亮顯示的選單項目 (兩個  
ENTER 按鈕作用相同)  
RETURN  
不保存改變而返回主選單  
22  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
(播放)開始播放。  
4
基本播放控制按鈕  
下表說明了遙控器上播放碟片用的基本控制  
如果您播放的DVDVCDVCD,可能  
會有一個選單出於如何使用選單的更多  
資訊,請參見25 DVD片選單”和第  
26VCD/VCDPBC 選單。  
按鈕。更多的播放功能將在5 詳細說明。  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
如果您播放的MP3據碟片上文件結  
構的複雜程放開始前可能需要幾秒鐘的  
時間。  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
如果您裝入的是一張包JPEGCD/CD-  
R/RW圖片會開始逐張放關於播放這些碟  
片的更多資請參見52JPEG碟  
。  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
如果碟片同時包MP3頻文件和JPEG圖  
像文同時參見71PhotoViewer  
(圖片瀏覽器。  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
使用  
按鈕 (或前  
5
面板  
MASTER VOLUME -/+  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
按鈕)調節音量。  
VOLUME  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
按鈕  
功能  
開始播放。  
DVDVCD如果顯示幕顯示  
Resume (恢復)或 Last Mem  
(最終記憶播放將從恢復位  
置或最終記憶位置開始播放 (請  
同時參恢復和最終記  
。  
23  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
按鈕  
功能  
暫停正放的,或重開  
始播放一張暫停的碟片。  
您可能發現DVD 碟片上的特定部  
些播放按鈕不起作不是故。  
停止播放。  
DVDVCD顯示幕顯示  
對於未最終完成的CD-R/RW碟於曲目  
選擇的曲目跳躍和數字按鈕不起作用。  
Resume  
(恢復再按 (停  
止)按鈕取消恢復功能請參  
見以恢復和最終記憶。)  
使用前面板控制按鈕  
前面板上的  
OPEN/CLOSE  
按此按始快。按  
(停止)按鈕的作用與遙控器上相應按鈕的  
作用完全相同。  
(播放)恢復正常播放。  
按此按始快。按  
(播放)恢復正常播放。  
恢復和最終記憶  
當您停止一DVDVCD片的播放示  
跳到當目或,然  
後至前一曲目/章。  
幕中顯示  
(恢復這表示您可以再  
Resume  
跳到下一曲目或章。  
次從該點開始恢復播放。  
FOLDER +/-  
(SUB)  
播放JPEGMP3碟片時跳至前一/  
下一文件夾。  
如果碟片托盤未打您在下一次開始播放  
時,顯示幕中顯示  
從恢復點恢復。  
(恢復且播放  
Resume  
數字  
用於輸題/曲分組章  
。按 ENTER 以選擇(或等待  
數秒鐘。  
DVD片︰如果您從播放機上取出碟片,  
播放位置將存入記憶您在下次裝入該碟  
示幕將顯Last Mem(最終記憶,  
如果碟片被停止播放,將從所  
選的標題/分DVD碟  
DVD碟)或曲目號對於  
這時您可以恢復播放(這個功能最多可用5  
張碟片。  
VCD/MP3  
SACD/CD/VCD/  
開始播放。  
如果您想清除恢復/最終記憶點,請在  
Resume Last Mem 出現時(停止)  
如果碟片正在播跳至所選  
的章或曲DVD碟,位  
於當前分組內始處進行播。  
按鈕。  
當裝入VCD果播放機被關閉或切換至  
DVD (CD) 以外的功能復點將丟。  
為了使用最終記憶功能,在打開碟片托盤  
前請務必按 (停止)停止播放。  
24  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
DVD有恢復和最終記憶功。  
我的電視機是標準屏幕(4:3將播放  
機設定為以全景掃pan & scan)格式  
顯示寬屏 DVD,那為什么在播放一些碟片  
時頂部和底部仍有黑條?  
最終記憶功能對VR格式的DVD-RW碟片不起  
作用。  
MP3式碟放無法恢是從  
播放停止時正在播放的文件所在文件夾的  
首個曲目開始播放。  
某些碟片忽略播放機的首選顯示方式,這  
樣即使您選擇了 4:3 (Pan & Scan),那些  
碟片仍以信箱格式顯示畫不是故。  
為什么我不能通過數位亮起輸出聽到 DVD  
唱碟SACD音頻?  
DVD片裝入後過幾秒鐘自動退出﹗  
DVDSACD頻僅通過模擬輸出端輸  
出。這並非故障。  
最大的可能是碟片不符合播放機的區域。  
碟片上應印有區域號,請與播放機的區域  
您可以在後面板上找到它)進行核  
對。請參見78DVD碟區域。  
我的DVD唱碟開始播隨後突然停止﹗  
該碟片可能是非法拷貝的。  
如果區域號正確,則可能是碟片損壞或髒  
清潔碟片並查看是否有損壞的跡。  
請參見78使用和保護碟片。  
DVD  
碟片選單  
DVDDVD碟帶有選可以通  
過該選單選擇要觀看或收聽的內些選單  
可能還提供附加功如字幕和伴音語言選  
擇,或者某些特殊功能,例如圖片放詳情  
請參見碟片包裝上的說明。  
為什么裝入的碟片無法播放?  
首先請檢查碟片的裝入方式是否正確(標  
籤面向上再檢查碟片是否清潔或有損  
壞。關於碟片的清潔請參見第 78 使  
用和保護碟片。  
DVD選單會在您開始播放時自動顯示,  
有時則僅在您按  
時顯示。  
DVD MENU  
TOP MENU  
如果碟片裝入正確但無法播放,則可能是  
格式或碟片類型不兼容,如 DVD-ROM。關  
於碟片兼容性的更多資訊請參見第 9 頁  
一般碟片兼容性。  
DVD碟具有附送類。要獲取這些分  
組,您必須輸入碟片包裝上的密碼。詳情  
請參見69。  
我的電視機是寬屏型,那為什么在播放一  
些碟片時屏幕頂部和底部有黑條?  
某些電影格式即使在寬屏電視機上播放,  
屏幕頂部和底部仍需有黑不是故。  
25  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
SOUND  
超級  
選單  
VCD/  
VCD PBC  
一些 VCD/ 超級 VCD 含有選單,您能夠從這個  
選單中選擇您想觀看的內容。它們被稱PBC  
(播放控制)選單。  
ENTER  
MUTE  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
播放PBCVCD/VCD時,您可以不用  
TV CONTROL  
PBC 選單,而是先按 (停止)按鈕,  
然後使用數字按鈕選擇曲目但不是  
(播  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
放)按或前面板上的  
)開始播放。  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
TUNE+  
4
ST–  
ST+  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
ENTER  
8
9
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
按鈕  
功能  
TOP MENU  
DVD頂層選單”  
-隨碟片而異。  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
DVD  
MENU  
DVD片選單-隨碟片而,  
並可能頂層選單”相同。  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
ꢂꢀꢁꢃ  
ENTER  
在屏幕上移動光標。  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
選定當前的選單選項。  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
RETURN  
返回至顯示。對  
某些具有可瀏覽圖片DVD,  
按該按鈕將顯示瀏覽器畫面。  
數字  
(主功能) 於某些碟片按  
高亮顯示編號的選單選項 (僅適  
以進行  
ENTER  
或等待數秒鐘。  
26  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
按鈕  
功能  
收聽收音機  
調諧器可以接FMAM記憶您最喜  
歡的電而無需每次在想要收聽時進行手  
動調諧。  
RETURN  
顯示 PBC單。  
數字按鈕  
選擇數字選單項目。  
顯示前一選單頁(如果有的話。  
顯示後一選單頁(如果有的話。  
按下選定高亮顯示的選單項目。  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
ENTER  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
如果系統尚未開啟,請按  
開啟。  
1
STANDBY/  
ON  
2
TUNER 切換至調諧器,然後反覆按該  
按鈕選擇 AM FM 波段。  
顯示幕顯示調諧器波段和頻率。  
3
調諧頻率。  
有三種調諧模式—手動模動模式和快速  
模式:  
27  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
手動調覆按  
改變所顯示的  
TUNE +/–  
記憶電臺  
您可以保存多達 30預設電臺,這樣您就無  
頻率。  
需每次進行手動調諧進入您喜歡的電臺。  
自動調住  
直至頻率顯示開  
TUNE +/–  
始移動,然後鬆開。調諧器將於發現下一  
電臺之後停止工作。重複該步驟,搜索其  
他電臺。  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
快速調TUNE +/–直至頻率顯示幕  
開始快速移動。一直按住該按鈕直至到達  
您所需的頻率。如有必要,請使用手動調  
諧方式對頻率進行微調。  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
改善不良的  
接收  
FM  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
如果以立體聲模式收聽 FM臺,但接收信號  
較弱,則您可以通過切換為單聲道來改善音  
質。  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
1
2
調諧至 FM 廣播電臺。  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
SYSTEM SETUP  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
使用  
(左/右光標鈕選“  
FM  
3
ꢂ/ꢃ  
然後按  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
ENTER  
Mode?  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
4
使用 ꢀ/(上/下光標鈕選FM  
Mono然後按 ENTER。  
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
當調諧器處於單聲道接收模式聲道指示  
亮起。  
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
選擇上方的  
返回至自動立體聲模式  
FM Auto  
﹝收聽立體聲廣播立體聲指示標誌( )  
亮起。  
調諧至  
廣播電臺。  
FM  
對於 FM段,請根據需要選擇單聲道接收或  
1
AM  
自動立體聲接收。該設置和預設一同保存。  
28  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
03  
開始使用  
2
3
SYSTEM SETUP  
收聽其他播放源  
您可以最多將四個外部播放電視機,衛  
星接收器等接至該系其中包括一個數  
位播放源。請同樣參見72頁連接輔助設  
。  
使用 ꢂ/ꢃ(左/右光標)按鈕選擇“St.  
Memory?然後按 ENTER。  
4
需的預設電臺。  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
使用  
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇您所  
30 個預設位置;每個位置可以保存一個  
預設電臺。  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
保存預設電臺。  
ENTER  
5
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
如果本系統完全和電源斷開,則所保存的  
電臺將保留若干天,在此之後您需重新保  
存這些電臺。  
如果系統尚未開啟,請按  
開啟。  
1
STANDBY/  
ON  
同時請務必開啟外部播放電視機,衛星  
接收器等。  
收聽預設電臺  
選擇您要收聽的播放源。  
2
3
1
2
務必選定 TUNER 功能。  
按鈕選擇預設電臺。  
TV 選擇 TV 或者使LINEL1/  
L2LINE 1 ANALINE1 DIG LINE  
2 ANA 輸入。  
ST +/–  
如有必要,請播放外部播放源。  
29  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
家庭影院的聲效  
4 章  
家庭影院的聲效  
使用該系能以立體聲或環繞聲模式盡情  
收聽各種模擬或數位播放源。  
用環繞聲進行收聽  
您能以環繞聲收聽一切立體聲或者多聲,模  
擬或數位的播放源。使用一種杜Pro Logic  
解碼模式的立體聲播放SACDDVD碟  
除外)可發出環繞聲。  
自動聽音模式  
自動聽音模式是按操作收聽一切播放源的最  
簡單方聲器的輸出反映了播放源資料的  
各聲道狀態。  
BASS MODE 
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
3
SYSTEM  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
SUBTITLE  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
HOME  
MENU  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
8
9
3
SYSTEM  
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
CLR  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
反覆按 SURROUND 選擇聽音模或按  
SURROUND 後使用 ꢀ/(上/下光標)按  
。  
選擇 “ ”聽音模式。  
Auto  
AUTO  
如果播放源採用了杜比數位DTS,則顯示幕  
上的 指示標誌將亮起。  
顯示幕中出現的聽音模式將根據所播放的播  
放源類型進行變化。  
2 DIGITAL  
DTS  
Auto  
-自動聽音模請參見上文)  
-杜比數位DTS解  
/
Dolby Digital DTS  
碼(取決於播放源於多聲道播放,  
該模式與  
當選擇了自動聽音模式時,之前所有開啟  
的杜Pro Logic高級環繞聲模式將被  
取消。  
相同。  
Auto  
-4.1聲道環繞聲用於所有的雙  
Pro Logic  
聲道播放源。  
Pro Logic II5.1道環繞  
PL II Movie  
聲,對於電影播放源尤為適合,並可用於  
所有的雙聲道播放源。  
30  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
家庭影院的聲效  
ProLogic II5.1道環繞  
PL II Music  
在杜比  
音樂模式開啟後,按  
Pro Logic II  
1
聲,對於音樂播放源尤為適合,並可用於  
所有的雙聲道播放源(請參見下文的“杜  
比Pro Logic II 音樂設定。  
SOUND  
2
ꢂ/ꢃ (左/右光標)按鈕選擇  
C WidthDimen.”或 “Pnrm.。  
C Width (中央寬度使中央聲道更寬  
Stereo -請參見下以立體聲模式收  
。  
(較高設定)或更較低設定)  
Dimen.  
(範圍使聲音更減設  
定)或更增加設定)  
(全景造更廣闊的環繞聲空間  
Pnrm.  
有關立體聲和環繞聲播放選項的詳細說  
明,請同樣參見第 32 使用高級環繞  
聲效果。  
(上/下光標)按鈕調節設定。  
3
ꢀ/ꢁ  
中央寬度可在 和 之間進行調節; 範圍可  
0
7
之間進行調節。全景可在  
On  
-3  
+3  
之間進行切換。  
Off  
4
ENTER 進行確認。  
您無法SACDDVD96kHz PCM源  
使用環繞聲模式。  
當接有耳機時,僅  
選項可用。  
Stereo  
以立體聲模式收聽  
您可以立體聲模式收聽一切立體聲或多聲道,  
模擬或數位的播放源。當播放多聲道播放源  
時,通過將所有聲道向下混合至前置左/前  
置右揚聲器以及超低音揚聲器從而產生立體  
聲。  
Dolby Digital DTS 模式進行收聽  
聲道資料將自動使用杜Pro Logic  
解碼方式以環繞聲進行播放。  
僅使用中央聲道的杜比數位DTS放源  
無法以環繞聲進行播放。  
BASS MODE 
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
杜比  
音樂設定  
Pro Logic II  
HOME  
MENU  
當在杜Pro Logic II 音樂模式下收聽時,  
您可以進一步調節三個參中央寬範圍  
和全景。  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
預設狀態︰  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
3
C Width︰  
Dimen.︰  
0
反覆按 SURROUND 直至顯示幕中出現  
Pnrm.︰  
Off  
Stereo。  
所有開啟的高級環繞聲模式將被取消。  
31  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
家庭影院的聲效  
使用高級環繞聲效果  
高級環繞聲效果可用於多聲道或立體聲播放  
源,以獲得各種附加的環繞聲效果。  
有關立體聲和環繞聲播放選項的詳細說  
明,請同樣參見下文“使用高級環繞聲效  
。  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
用耳機收聽  
當連接了耳機時,只有  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
(預設)和  
Stereo  
(耳機虛擬環繞聲)模式  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
Phones Surround  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
有效。  
接有耳機時,請按  
選擇  
ADVANCED  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
”或 按  
選擇  
SURROUND  
Phones Surround  
”。  
TV CONTROL  
Stereo  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
選擇高級環繞聲模式﹝或  
ADVANCED  
然後用  
(上/下光標)  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
ADVANCED  
按鈕。  
反覆按該按鈕從以下項目中選擇:  
-賦予音樂廳類型的聲音  
Adv. Music  
-賦予影院類型的聲音  
Adv. Movie  
Expanded -創造極寬廣的立體聲聲場  
TV Surr. -設計用於單聲道或立體聲電視  
廣播和其他播放源  
32  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
家庭影院的聲效  
-設計用於體育節目和其他評論節  
Sports  
增強對話  
預設狀態:  
Dialog Off  
Game -創造視頻遊戲播放源的環繞聲  
對話增強功能設計用於使電視或電影音軌中  
的對話聲比其他背景聲更顯著。  
ExPwrSurr.(超強環繞聲賦予立體聲  
播放源更大的能量與寬度  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
ADVANCED  
Virtual  
-僅創造出來自前置揚聲器的環  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
繞聲效果  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
-設計用於對立體聲音樂播放  
5ch Stereo  
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
源帶來強勁的環繞聲  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
您無法對SACDDVD唱碟和96 kHzPCM放  
源使用高級環繞聲模式。  
反覆按該按鈕從以下項目中選擇:  
DIALOGUE 選擇對話增強的大小。  
您可以對任何類型的播放源使用上述任何  
一種的高級環繞聲模式。給定的說明僅作  
參考。  
-無對話增強  
Dialog Off  
Dialog Mid  
Dialog Max  
-適度的對話增強  
-有力的對話增強  
當接有耳機,僅  
可用。  
選項  
Phones Surround  
調節高級環繞聲效果等級  
您可以隨意對高級環繞聲模式的效果進行增  
強或減對於各高級環繞聲模您可以分  
別對效果等級進行設置。  
您無法SACDDVD唱碟和96 kHz PCM播放  
源使用對話增強功能。  
在高級環繞聲模式開啟後,按  
SOUND  
1
2
ꢂ/ꢃ (左/右光標)按鈕選擇  
Effect。  
3
級。  
(上/下光標)按鈕調節效果等  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
效果等級可以在 (最小最大之  
10  
90  
間進行調節。  
進行確認。  
ENTER  
4
33  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
家庭影院的聲效  
用虛擬後置環繞聲揚聲器收聽  
預設狀態:  
使用安靜和午夜聽音模式  
預設狀態:  
Off  
Vir. SB Off  
當以環繞聲模式收聽使用虛擬後置環繞  
聲功能來模擬附加的後置環繞聲聲真正  
的影院置環繞聲揚聲器應該位於您的正  
後方,以創造更多連續而逼真的環繞聲。  
安靜收聽功能可降低聲音播放源中過多的低  
音或高果音樂有點刺耳但您更喜歡較為  
柔滑的聲音,則可以使用該功能。  
午夜收聽功能讓您能在低音量級的情況下聽  
到電影中實際的環繞效果自動根據您正  
在收聽的音量進行調節。  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SETUP  
SUBTITLE  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
8
9
3
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
CLR  
4
ROOM SETUP  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
MAIN  
SUB  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
反覆按  
“  
”和  
Vir. SB On  
VIRTUAL SB  
”之間進行切換。  
Vir. SB Off  
反覆按  
“  
”,  
QUIET/MIDNIGHT  
Quiet  
”和 “ ”之間進行切換。  
Midnight  
Off  
當以  
Stereo Virtual  
聽音模式收聽,您  
無法使用虛擬後置環繞。  
當接有耳機時,您無法使用虛擬後置環繞  
聲。  
當接有耳機時,在下列情況下,您不能設定  
安靜/午夜聽音模式。  
如果沒有環繞聲聲道,虛擬後置環繞聲將  
不起作用。  
SACDDVD碟時。  
您無法對SACDDVD碟和96 kHz PCM音源  
使用虛擬後置環繞聲效果。  
34  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
家庭影院的聲效  
調節低音和高音  
增強低音等級  
您可以使用三種低音模式來增強播放源中的  
預設狀態:高音: ,低音:  
0
0
低音。  
使用低音和高音控制按鈕調節全部音調開  
啟了安靜或午夜模式法進行低音和高音  
調節。  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
反覆按  
選擇適合您正在收聽  
的播放源的選項。  
BASS MODE  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
-可用於音樂,以帶來較為低沉的  
Music  
低音  
1
2
SOUND  
-適用於動作片或具有許多聲音  
Cinema  
(左/右光標鈕選“  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
Bass  
效果的電影  
或 “  
”。  
Treble  
P. Bass -可用於音樂播放在最前方  
產生音或音軌)的節拍聲  
Off  
(上/下光標)按鈕調節聲音。  
3
ꢀ/ꢁ  
低音和高音可-3 +3 之間進行調節。  
4
ENTER 進行確認。  
您無法SACDDVD碟使用低音模。  
當接有耳機時,在下列情況下,您不能調節  
高音/低音。  
當接有耳機時,您無法使用低音模式。  
錄音模式設ON時  
SACDDVD碟時  
35  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
04  
家庭影院的聲效  
靜音  
如果您需要暫時關閉揚聲器中的聲使用  
按鈕。  
MUTE  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
要取消靜音或調節音量,請再次按  
MUTE  
執行靜音。  
MUTE  
36  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
5 章  
播放碟片  
,從屏幕提示中選擇  
HOME MENU  
1
介紹  
碟片導向。  
Disc Navigator  
如果裝入的VRDVD-RW、CD、VCD/  
本章介紹的大部分功能都採用了螢幕顯。關  
於如何導向它們的說明請參見21使用  
螢幕顯示。  
VCDMP3/JPEG片,您也可以選擇按  
按鈕,它使您可直接進入碟片導  
DVD MENU  
本章介紹的大部分功能都適用於 DVD 碟片和  
SACDVCDVCD、CDMP3/JPEG,  
盡管其中一些實際操作會隨裝入碟片的種類  
而略有差異。  
向畫面。  
HOME MENU  
DVD  
Play Mode  
Video Adjust  
DVD片限制某些功能的使用(例,隨  
機播放或重複播放這並非故障。  
Disc Navigator  
Initial Settings  
在播放 VCD 超級 VCD 時,某些功能無法在  
PBC放過程中使用。如果您要使用它們,請  
通過數字按鈕選擇曲目來開始播放碟片。  
選擇您想播放的部分。  
2
根據裝入碟片的種類,導向畫面看上去略  
有不同。  
DVD碟的畫面在左面顯示標面顯示。  
請選定一個標題或標題中的章。  
要進入遙控器上呈綠色顯示的各功能,請  
將滑動開關MAIN SUB。  
Disc Navigator  
Title 1-10  
Chapter 1-3  
使用碟片導向瀏覽碟片內容  
使用碟片導向來瀏覽碟片內容以找到您想播  
放的部可以在碟片播放或停止時使用碟  
片導向。  
DVD  
Title 01  
Title 02  
Title 03  
Title 04  
Title 05  
Title 06  
Title 07  
Title 08  
Chapter 001  
Chapter 002  
Chapter 003  
DVD選擇一個分組或分組內的曲  
目。  
Disc Navigator  
Group 1-3  
Track 1-36  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
Track 05  
Track 06  
Track 07  
Track 08  
Group 01  
Group 02  
Group 03  
DVD-Audio  
37  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
對於 SACD,請選擇當前播放區域內的一個曲  
目。  
MP3 碟片的屏幕顯示畫面在左邊顯示文件夾  
名,在右邊顯示曲目請注意,如果有 16  
個以上的文件夾或曲目名稱包含重音符或非  
羅馬字曲目和文件夾名將以類屬名顯示  
Disc Navigator  
Track 1-14  
2ch Area  
F_033 T_035  
。  
Track 001  
Track 002  
Track 003  
Track 004  
Track 005  
選定一個文件夾或文件夾中的曲目。  
Track 006  
Track 007  
Track 008  
Disc Navigator  
Folder 1-17  
Track 1-10  
MP3  
001. ACP  
002. Nth Degree  
003. Pfeuti  
001. Gravity deluxe  
002.Tesla's patent  
003. Border dispute  
004. Delayed by rain  
005. Accident incident  
006. Pigeon post  
VR視頻錄製)模式DVD-RW片,  
請在碟片或標題的  
004. Live  
(播放列表)和  
Playlist  
(原始)區域中選擇一個,或選擇  
005. Glitch music  
006. CodHead  
007.Thermo  
008. Missing Man  
Original  
一個標題。按  
007. Outernational  
008. Vacuum tube  
(右光標)預覽標題。  
在播放過程中無法在  
(原始和  
Original  
(播放列表)之間進行切換。  
播放將在按動  
後開始。  
ENTER  
Playlist  
並非所VRDVD-RW片都具有  
Playlist播放列表。  
碟片導向只有在碟片裝入後才能使  
用。  
Disc Navigator  
Title(1-3)  
DVD-RW  
Original  
01. 3/31 FIRST LEAGUE  
02. 4/28 SECOND LEAGUE  
03. 4/29 FINAL ROUND  
如果以PBC模式播放VCD超級VCD者播  
放的是一張未最終完成的 CD-R/RW 碟片,  
碟片導向功能將無法使用。  
Play List  
查找碟片特定位置的另一方法是使用搜索  
模式中的一種。請參見第 47 搜索碟  
。  
CD VCD超級 VCD 的畫面顯示曲目列表。  
(以下畫面CD例)  
Disc Navigator  
Track 1-10  
掃描碟片  
您可以使用各種不同的速度向前或向後快速  
CD  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
Track 05  
Track 06  
Track 07  
Track 08  
掃描碟片。  
在碟片播放時,按  
開始掃。  
1
2
反覆按以加快掃描速度。  
MP3目只能用一種速度掃描。  
掃描速度將螢幕顯示。  
38  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
(播放)恢復正常播放。  
(播放)恢復正常播放。  
3
4
在掃描CD唱SACD和MP3碟片時您能聽見  
聲音。  
VCDVCD支持前進的慢動作播。  
慢動作播放的畫面質有正常播放的  
好。  
當掃描VCD超級VCD或MP3的某個曲目,  
播放將自動在該曲目的起點或終點處開  
始。  
根據碟片類型,在到達新的章時可能自動  
恢復正常播放。  
掃描DVD影碟和VCD超級VCD有聲音  
輸出。掃DVD碟時沒有字幕顯示。  
逐幀前進/逐幀倒退  
根據碟片類到達DVD影碟上某個新的  
章時可能自動恢復正常播放。  
您可以逐幀前進或倒退播放 DVDVR格  
式的 DVD-RW片。對於 VCD超級 VCD,您  
僅能使用逐幀前進播放。  
慢動作播放  
1
。  
在碟片播放時按 (暫停上面板上的  
您能夠以四種不同的慢速播DVDDVD-  
R/RWVCDVCDDVD影碟DVD-R/RW  
還能以兩種慢速倒退播放。  
ꢆ/ꢇ ꢉ/ꢊ  
每次倒退或前進一。  
2
3
(播放上面板上的  
)恢復正  
1
2
播放(暫停上面板上的 。  
按住 直到慢動作播放開  
常播放。  
ꢆ/ꢇ  
ꢉ/ꢊ  
始。  
慢動作播放速度螢幕顯示。  
慢動作播放時沒有聲音輸出。  
使用逐幀倒退時的畫面質量沒有逐幀前進  
的好。  
3
反覆按該按鈕改變慢速播放的速度。  
根據碟片類型,到達新的章節時可能自動  
恢復正常播放。  
慢速播放的速度螢幕顯示。  
DVD改變播放方向面會  
以無法預期的方式“移動這並非故。  
39  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
在 “  
)”( 終點處  
4
B
End Point  
,以設定循環終點。  
B
循環播放碟片上的某一段  
ENTER  
A-B複功能讓您能夠指定曲CDVCD)  
或標題(DVD 影碟DVD-RW)中的兩個點(A  
和B以形成反覆播放的循環段。  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
A(Start Point)  
B(End Point)  
Off  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
MP3DVDSACDVCD、  
PBC式下VCD未最終完成的CD-R/RW  
碟片,您不能使A-B複功能。  
在您按  
按鈕後,播放跳回到起點開始  
ENTER  
循環播放。  
最小循環時間2鐘。  
在碟片播放時,按  
選擇  
1
HOME MENU  
播放模式。  
Play Mode  
要恢復正常播放在選單中選擇“  
5
(關閉。  
Off  
2
從左邊功能列表中選擇 “A-B Repeat”  
(重複播放。  
Play Mode  
使用重複播放  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
A(Start Point)  
B(End Point)  
Off  
重複播放的選項隨裝入碟片的類型而也  
可以與編序播放一起使用重複播重複播  
放編序列表中的曲目/見第 43 頁  
創建編序列表。  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
在 “  
)”( 起點處  
Start Point  
3
A
A
,以設定循環起點。  
ENTER  
PBC式下的VCD超級VCD或未最終  
完成CD-R/RW片,您無法使用重複播  
放。  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
A(Start Point)  
B(End Point)  
Off  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
40  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
對於 SACD、CDVCDVCD,選擇  
Disc  
(曲目  
Track Repeat  
使用  
OSD  
(碟片重複或  
Repeat  
重複或者  
1
在碟片播放時,按 HOME MENU 選擇  
(重複播放關閉。  
Repeat Off  
Play Mode播放模式。  
Play Mode  
2
Repeat  
從左邊的功能列表中選擇“ 重  
複播放。  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Disc Repeat  
Track Repeat  
Repeat Off  
Random  
Play Mode  
Program  
Search Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Title Repeat  
Chapter Repeat  
Repeat Off  
Random  
Program  
對於 MP3 碟片,選擇  
(碟片重  
Disc Repeat  
Search Mode  
、  
(文件夾重複或  
Folder Repeat  
Track  
(重  
Repeat Off  
(曲目重複或者  
Repeat  
3
選擇重複播放選項。  
複播放關閉〕。  
如果編序播放已激活,請選Program  
Repeat (編序重複)以重複播放編序列表,  
或選Repeat Off (重複播放關閉)以取消  
重複播放。  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Disc Repeat  
Folder Repeat  
Track Repeat  
Repeat Off  
Random  
Program  
Title Repeat  
對於DVD影碟或DVD-RW碟擇  
Search Mode  
Chapter Repeat  
重複)或  
〔或者  
(章重複)  
Repeat Off  
(重複播放關閉〕。  
Play Mode  
使用顯示幕  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Title Repeat  
碟片播放時,按  
放選項。  
選擇一個重複播  
REPEAT  
Chapter Repeat  
Repeat Off  
Random  
Program  
反覆按直到您所要的重複播放選項顯示在顯  
示幕上。  
Search Mode  
重複播放選項OSD的選參見上文相  
同。  
DVD碟,選擇  
(分組  
Group Repeat  
重複)或  
(曲目重複或者  
Track Repeat  
(重複播放關閉〕。  
Repeat Off  
Play Mode  
如果您已創建了一個編序列表,也可使用  
Program Repeat。  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Group Repeat  
Track Repeat  
Repeat Off  
Random  
在播放期可以CLR取消重複播。  
Program  
Search Mode  
41  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
選擇隨機播放選項。  
DVD碟,請選擇  
3
(隨機  
Random Title  
播放標題)或  
(隨機播放  
Random Chapter  
(隨機播放關閉〕。  
您不能同時使用重複和隨機播放。  
或  
Random Off  
如果您在重複播放過程中切換了視角,重  
複播放將被取消。  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Random Title  
Repeat  
Random Chapter  
Random Off  
使用隨機播放  
Random  
您可使用隨機播放功能以隨機順序播放標題  
DVD 影碟分組或曲目 (DVD 唱碟)  
或曲SACDCDVCD超級VCD和MP3碟片。  
Program  
Search Mode  
您可以在碟片正在播放或被停止播放時設定  
隨機播放選項。  
DVD碟,請選擇  
(隨  
Random Group  
機播放分組)或  
(隨機播放  
Random Track  
曲目或  
(隨機播放關閉。  
Random Off  
Play Mode  
對於VR格式的DVD-RW碟PBC模式下播放  
VCDVCDDVD片選單正  
在顯示時,您不能使用隨機播放。  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Random Group  
Random Track  
Random Off  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
OSD  
使用  
對於 CDVCD超級 VCD,請選擇 On (打  
在碟片播放時,按  
選擇  
1
HOME MENU  
開)Off(關閉)以打開或關閉隨機播放。  
播放模式。  
Play Mode  
2
從左 邊的 功能 列表中 選擇 “Random”  
(隨機播放。  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
On  
Off  
Random  
Play Mode  
Program  
Search Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Random Title  
Random Chapter  
Random Off  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
42  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
MP3片,請選擇  
(隨機播  
Random All  
放全部所有文件夾或  
(隨  
Random Track  
機播放曲限於當或  
(隨機播放關閉〕。  
對於VR格式的DVD-RW碟PBC模式下播放  
VCDVCD,或者DVD片選單  
正在顯示時,您不能使用編序播放功能。  
Random Off  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Random All  
Random Track  
Random Off  
OSD  
使用  
Random  
Program  
在碟片播放時,按  
選擇  
1
HOME MENU  
Search Mode  
播放模式。  
Play Mode  
2 從 左邊的 功能列 表中選 擇 “Program”  
(編序播放。  
Play Mode  
您也可以使用遙控器上RANDOM 按鈕  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Create/Edit  
Playback Start  
Playback Stop  
Program Delete  
Program Memory  
來選擇隨機播放模式。隨機播放模式將在  
顯示幕和在屏畫面上顯示。可用的隨機播  
放模式Play Mode 選擇。ENTER 選  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
Off  
單中可選擇的相同。  
要停止碟片並取消隨機播(停  
。  
從編序選項的列表中選擇“  
3
(創建/編輯。  
Create/Edit  
要取消隨機播放功能而不停止播放,請按  
Play Mode  
CLR  
碟片將播放至結然後停。  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Create/Edit  
在隨機播放,  
按鈕功能與正常  
Playback Start  
Playback Stop  
Program Delete  
Program Memory  
狀態下略有不同︰  
返回到當前曲目/  
Random  
Program  
章的開始處。您無法再進一步返回。  
Search Mode  
Off  
從其餘部分中隨機選取其他曲目/章。  
您無法與編序播放或重複播放一起使用隨  
機播放功能。  
所顯示的編序編輯畫面根據裝入碟片的種類  
而異。  
畫面左邊是編序列表,右邊是標題列如  
果裝入的DVD分組列表(如果裝入  
DVDSACDCDVCD  
VCD)或者是文件夾列表(對MP3碟  
最右邊是DVD碟)或曲目名  
MP3)的列表。  
創建編序列表  
本功能讓您能夠編製碟片上標題/組/章/  
文件夾/曲目的播放順序。  
43  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
在編序列表中為當前步驟選擇一個標題、  
4
章、分組、文件夾或曲目。  
要添加曲目,請先高亮顯示分組,然後按  
(右光標)並從列表中選擇一個曲目。  
DVD可以將整個標題或標題內的  
章添加至編序列表。  
Program  
Program Step  
Group 1-38  
Track 1-4  
01. 01-003  
02.  
Group 01  
Group 02  
Group 03  
Group 04  
Group 05  
Group 06  
Group 07  
Group 08  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
要添加標題,請選擇該標題。  
03.  
04.  
Program  
05.  
06.  
Program Step  
Title 1~38  
Chapter 1~4  
07.  
01. 01  
02.  
Title 01  
Title 02  
Title 03  
Title 04  
Title 05  
Title 06  
Title 07  
Title 08  
Chapter 001  
Chapter 002  
Chapter 003  
Chapter 004  
08.  
03.  
04.  
05.  
對於 SACD、CD VCD VCD,選擇一個  
06.  
07.  
曲目以添加到編序列表中。  
08.  
Program  
Program Step  
Track 1~12  
要添加章,先高亮顯示其所在標題,然後  
01. 04  
02.  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
Track 05  
Track 06  
Track 07  
Track 08  
按 (右光標從列表中選擇一個章。  
03.  
04.  
Program  
05.  
06.  
Program Step  
Title 1-38  
Chapter 1-4  
07.  
01. 01-003  
02.  
Title 01  
Title 02  
Title 03  
Title 04  
Title 05  
Title 06  
Title 07  
Title 08  
Chapter 001  
Chapter 002  
Chapter 003  
Chapter 004  
08.  
03.  
04.  
05.  
MP3可以將整個文件夾或文件夾  
內的曲目添加至編序列表中。  
06.  
07.  
08.  
要添加文件夾,請選擇該文件夾。  
DVD可以將整個分組或分組內的  
曲目添加至編序列表。  
Program  
Program Step  
Folder 1-6  
Track 1-10  
01. 001  
02.  
001. ACP  
001. Gravity deluxe  
002.Tesla's patent  
003. Border dispute  
004. Delayed by rain  
005. Accident incident  
006. Pigeon post  
要添加分組,請選擇該分組。  
002. Nth Degree  
003. Pfeuti  
03.  
04.  
004. Live  
Program  
05.  
005. Glitch music  
006. CodHead  
06.  
Program Step  
Group 1~38  
Track 1~4  
07.  
007. Outernational  
008. Vacuum tube  
01. 01  
02.  
Group 01  
Group 02  
Group 03  
Group 04  
Group 05  
Group 06  
Group 07  
Group 08  
Track 01  
Track 02  
Track 03  
Track 04  
08.  
03.  
04.  
05.  
06.  
07.  
08.  
44  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
要添加一個曲目,先找到其文件夾,然後  
播放時,按  
選擇 “  
HOME MENU Play  
1
(右光標)並從列表中選擇一個曲  
”。  
Mode  
目名稱。  
2 從左邊功能列表中選定 “Program編  
。  
Program  
Program Step  
Folder 1-6  
Track 1-10  
3
(創建/編輯。  
Create/Edit  
從編 序選項列表中 選定 “  
01. 001-003  
001. ACP  
001. Gravity deluxe  
002.Tesla's patent  
003. Border dispute  
004. Delayed by rain  
005. Accident incident  
006. Pigeon post  
02.  
03.  
04.  
05.  
06.  
07.  
08.  
002. Nth Degree  
003. Pfeuti  
004. Live  
005. Glitch music  
006. CodHead  
要清除一個步驟,請高亮顯示該步驟號並  
4
007. Outernational  
008. Vacuum tube  
CLR  
5
要在編序列表中插入一個步驟,請高亮打  
選擇標題/章/分組/文件夾/曲  
ENTER  
算讓新步驟出現在該處的步選定一個要  
加入的標題/章/分組/文件夾/曲目。  
ENTER 後,新的步驟被插入列表。  
目後,步驟號將自動向下移動一步。  
重複步驟 ,以建立編序列表。  
4
5
6
一個編序列表最多可以包24 個標題/章/  
分組/文件夾/曲目。  
要在編序列表末尾增加一個步驟,請高亮  
顯示新步驟要插入位置的步選定一個要  
增加的標題/章/分組/文件夾/曲目。  
6
要按編序列表播放,按 (播放)按。  
編序播放將保持激活狀到您關閉編序播  
放(參見下文除編序列表(參見下文、  
退出碟片或關閉播放機或切換DVD (CD)以  
要保存編序列表,退出編序列表編輯畫面  
外的其他功能。  
HOME MENU  
而不開始播放,請按  
如果您想不保存所作的修改並退出編序列  
表編輯畫面,請按  
RETURN  
要保存您的編序列表並退出編序編輯畫面  
但不開始播HOME MENU請  
勿按 RETURN -這樣做不能保存編序列  
OSD 編序選單的其他功能  
通過播放模式選除了能創建和編輯編序  
列表,還能夠開始編序播放,取消編序播放,  
刪除編序列表和記憶編序列表。  
。  
編序播放將跳至編序列表中的  
下一步。  
播放時按  
可關閉編序播播放停止  
CLR  
時按該按鈕可刪除編序列表。  
使用 OSD 編輯編序列表  
在編序列表創建您可以增加除或改變  
其中的步驟。  
45  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
選擇 “ 。  
Play Mode  
1
2
HOME MENU  
使用本機顯示幕  
儘管 OSDSACD,CDMP3片,但顯  
示幕仍提供了充足資訊以方便地創建編序列  
表。如果正在播放一張碟片,請先停止播放。  
從左邊功能列表中選定 “Program編  
。  
Play Mode  
1
PROGRAM。  
A-B Repeat  
Create/Edit  
提示您在編序列表中首先輸入一首曲目或文  
件夾。  
Repeat  
Playback Start  
Playback Stop  
Program Delete  
Program Memory  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
Off  
P - 0 0  
0 0 0  
2
目,按  
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇一首曲  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
選定編序播放功能。  
3
ENTER  
建/編輯)-請參見前  
Create/Edit  
述內容  
P - 0 1  
5 3 7  
(開始播放)-開始播放  
Playback Start  
已保存的編序列表  
僅限 MP3片:要選擇文件夾中的單個曲  
目,請用 ꢀ/ꢁ (上/下光標)按鈕選擇  
文件夾後,,然後ꢀ/(上/下  
光標)按鈕選擇一首曲目。ENTER。  
Playback Stop (停止播放)-關閉編序  
播放,但不刪除編序列表  
Program Delete  
序列表並關閉編序播放  
(刪除編序)-刪除編  
在完成各種選擇之後,等待顯示幕對您的提  
CLR  
示。如果您未正確操作,請按  
最近一首)編序曲目。  
刪除最後  
(編序記憶(僅對於  
Program Memory  
DVDOn保存所裝入碟片的  
重複步驟 創建編序列表。  
3
一個編序列表可包含多24曲目。  
2
編序列表選定  
的編序記憶)  
則取消所裝入碟片  
Off  
要播放編序列表,請按 (播放。  
4
編序播放將保持開啟直至您按下 (停止,  
清除播放列請參見下文出碟片或關  
閉播放機為止。  
可對裝入的DVD碟片保存編序列您裝  
入一張保存有編序列表的碟片時,編序播  
放將自動開啟。  
清除編序列表  
要編製新的編序列必須清除原有編序列  
您可以保存多24碟片的編序列。此  
後,最早保存的播放列表將被最新保存的  
播放列表取代。  
表。  
1
2
如果正在播放一張碟(停止。  
CLR  
46  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
某些DVD唱碟具有可瀏覽圖片的頁輸  
入您要的頁碼。  
搜索碟片  
您可以通過標題或章號碼或通過時間對DVD影  
碟碟片進行搜DVD碟可分組或按曲目  
或按頁碼進行搜索,對 SACD,CD 超級 VCD  
可以通過曲目號進行搜VCD通過曲目  
號或時間進行搜MP3片則可以通過文  
件夾或曲目號進行搜索。  
5
ENTER 開始播放。  
您僅能對DVD影碟和VCD碟片使用時間搜索  
功能。  
1
在播放過程中,按 HOME MENU 選擇  
要使用時間搜索功片必須正在播。  
Play Mode。  
PBC模式下VCD超級VCD或未最終  
2
(搜索模式。  
Search Mode  
從左邊功能列表中選“  
完成CD-R/RW片,搜索功能不可用。  
顯示的搜索選項根據裝入碟片的類型而。以  
下畫面顯示DVD碟搜索選項。  
對於兩張以上SACD第二張碟片  
過後,您可能無法選擇碟片的首個曲目。  
Play Mode  
播放  
唱碟的 “附送類”  
DVD  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Title Search  
DVD碟具有額外的附送些分組需  
要4數的密碼才能獲取。詳情和有關密碼,  
請參見碟片包裝。當您嘗試播放附送本播  
放機將自動提示您輸入密碼。  
Chapter Search  
Time Search  
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
使用數字按鈕輸入 位數密碼。  
4
也可以通過選項選單輸入密碼。請參見第  
69。  
1
3
4
選定一個搜索模式。  
用數字按鈕輸入標題、組、章、文件夾或  
曲目號,或者是時間或頁碼。  
切換字幕  
Play Mode  
DVD碟具有一種或多種語言的字,碟  
片包裝盒一般會告知有哪些字幕語言可以使  
用。您能夠在碟片播放時切換字幕語言。  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Title Search  
Input Chapter  
Chapter Search  
Time Search  
0
0
1
Random  
Program  
Search Mode  
反覆按  
選定一個字幕選項。  
SUBTITLE  
Current / Total  
Subtitle 1/2  
English  
對時間搜索,請將您希望碟片播放恢復位  
置的分鐘和秒數輸入到當前正在播放的標  
DVD 影/DVD-RW曲目(VCD中。  
例如,按 4500 讓播放從碟片上的  
有些碟片只允許您從碟片選單來改變字幕  
語言。TOP MENU 可進入碟片選單。  
45鐘處起開始。對 120 30,  
8030。  
47  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
要設置字幕首選項,請參見65頁  
切換 VCD 超級 VCD 的音頻  
聲道  
當播VCDVCD,您可以在立體聲、  
Subtitle Language字幕語言。  
僅左聲道或僅右聲道之間進行切換。  
切換 影碟伴音語言  
在播放錄有兩種以上語言對白DVD碟時,  
DVD  
反覆按 AUDIO 選擇一個音頻聲道選項。  
您能夠在播放中切換伴音語言。  
反覆按  
選定一個伴音語言選項。  
Audio  
Stereo  
AUDIO  
Current /Total  
1/2  
Audio  
French  
Dolby Digital 3/2.1CH  
放大屏幕畫面  
在欣DVD碟,DVD 唱碟VCDVCD  
時,能夠利用放大功能將畫面的一部分放大  
2 倍4。  
有些碟片只允許您從碟片選單來改變音頻  
語言。TOP MENU 可進入碟片選單。  
在播放中用  
按鈕選擇放大倍數。  
1
ZOOM  
(正常)  
Normal  
2x  
要設置伴音語言首選項,請參見第 65 頁  
Audio Language伴音語言。  
4x  
DVD  
根據碟片類DVD碟時您可以切換聲  
切換  
唱碟的音頻聲道  
道-詳情請參見碟片盒。  
反覆按  
選擇一個音頻聲道選項。  
1
AUDIO  
Zoom 2x  
Digital Out Converted  
Linear PCM 192kHz24bit  
2CH  
Audio  
1
當您改變音頻聲道放將自當前曲目的起  
始處重新開始。  
Zoom 4x  
某些碟片僅容許您通過碟片選單改變音頻  
按  
可進入碟片選單。  
TOP MENU  
DVD影DVD唱碟或VCDVCD的  
分辨率是固定的,因此圖像質量會有所下  
其是4放大這不是故。  
要設置伴音語言首選項,請參見第 65 頁  
Audio Language伴音語言。  
48  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
用光標按鈕改變放大區域。  
DVD碟顯示  
2
您可以在播放過程中隨意地改變放大倍數和  
放大區域。  
Play  
DVD  
Current / Total Elapsed  
11/38 2.05  
Remain  
4.57  
Total  
7.02  
Title  
French  
Audio Dolby Digital 3/2.1CH  
English  
Subtitle  
1
如果屏幕頂部向方框消失,請再按  
ZOOM 使其顯示。  
Angle  
Play  
DVD  
Current / Total Elapsed  
11/38 2.05  
Remain  
4.57  
Total  
7.02  
Chapter  
Tr. Rate  
8.6Mbps  
當屏幕畫面被放大時,我們建議不要使用  
DVD 碟片選單,因為此時選單選項將無法  
高亮顯示。  
DVD碟顯示  
Play  
DVD-Audio  
Current / Total  
1/14  
Elapsed  
3.20  
Remain  
2.41  
Total  
6.01  
Track  
Audio  
如果您顯示了字幕,當屏幕畫面被放大時  
它們會消失。當屏幕畫面回到正常大小時  
它們會再次出現。  
- -  
1
1
Linear PCM  
Subtitle  
Angle  
192kHz 24bit 2/0CH  
-Audio  
DVD  
Play  
Current / Total  
1/3  
Elapsed  
3.21  
Remain  
53.20  
Total  
56.41  
Group  
Tr. Rate  
:
9.5Mbps  
切換視角  
某些DVD碟具有以兩個以上角度拍攝的畫面  
VRDVD-RW示  
-詳情請參閱碟片包裝盒。  
Play  
Title  
DVD-RW  
Original  
Elapsed  
0.08  
Current / Total  
1/32  
Remain  
30.22  
Total  
30.30  
當多視角畫面被播放時,屏幕上會出現一個  
圖標,以讓您知道還可觀看其他角度的  
如果您愿意,也可關閉這項功能-請  
參見67 Angle Indicator角度指示  
。  
1
- -  
Audio Dolby Digital  
2/0CH  
Subtitle  
Play  
DVD-RW  
Original  
Current / Total  
1/1  
Chapter  
Tr. Rate  
4.3Mbps  
在碟片播或暫停時,按 ANGLE 切換  
視角。  
SACD示  
Play  
Track  
SACD  
Current / Total  
1/14  
Elapsed  
0.13  
Remain  
4.21  
Total  
4.34  
顯示碟片資訊  
在播DVD幕上可顯示碟片的各種  
(僅在多聲道播放過程中)  
曲目,章和標題資訊以及視頻傳輸率。  
Play  
SACD  
Elapsed  
0.22  
Current / Total  
1/9  
Remain  
3.38  
Total  
4.00  
Track  
3/2.1CH  
碟片資訊  
OSD  
Audio  
要顯示/切換所顯示的資訊,請按  
Play  
Disc  
SACD  
Elapsed  
0.05  
Remain  
73.00  
Total  
73.05  
DISPLAY。  
在碟片被播放資訊出現在屏幕頂部。按住  
以改變顯示的資訊。  
DISPLAY  
49  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
CDVCD示  
Play  
CD  
Current / Total  
2/16  
Elapsed  
1.07  
Remain  
4.40  
Total  
5.47  
Track  
Play  
Disc  
CD  
Elapsed  
28.00  
Remain  
30.20  
Total  
58.20  
(僅PBC放過程中)  
Play  
VCD  
VCD示  
Play  
CD  
Current / Total  
2/16  
Elapsed  
1.07  
Track  
MP3片顯示  
Play  
MP3  
Current / Total  
1/17  
Elapsed  
0.18  
Remain  
12.42  
Total  
13.00  
Track  
Track Name  
Outernational  
Play  
MP3  
Current / Total  
2/7  
Folder  
Folder Name ACP  
JPEG片顯示  
Play  
JPEG  
Current / Total  
1/40  
File  
File Name  
FL000001  
Play  
JPEG  
Current / Total  
2/6  
Folder  
Folder Name Holiday  
您能夠從碟片導向畫面中看到碟片資訊  
(標題/、組、件夾等的數目。  
請參見第 37 使用碟片導向瀏覽碟片  
內容。  
50  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
05  
播放碟片  
顯示幕資訊  
有限的碟片資訊也出現在前面板顯示幕。按  
改變顯示的資訊。  
VCD示  
曲目號  
已播放碟片時間  
4
11 1 6  
DISPLAY  
DVDDVD-RW示  
剩餘碟片時間  
5 3 1 5  
3 2 0  
Disc  
4
標題號  
章號  
已播放標題時間  
2
2
8 4 9  
曲目號  
剩餘曲目時間  
VCD示  
標題號  
剩餘標題時間  
2
2
TTL 1 0 7 0 0  
曲目號  
已播放曲目時間  
4
1 1 6  
標題號  
章號  
剩餘章時間  
2
0 4 2  
MP3片顯示  
曲目號  
已播放曲目時間  
2
0 3 5  
DVD碟  
曲目名稱  
組號  
曲目號  
已播放曲目時間  
E V E R Y B O D  
B E S T _ O F _  
2
2
2
2
8 4 9  
3 1 5  
文件夾名稱  
組號  
曲目號  
剩餘曲目時間  
2
JPEG片顯示  
文件名稱  
T I G E R _ 0 1  
組號  
剩餘組時間  
GRP 1 4 7 0 0  
文件夾名稱  
Z O O _ T R I P  
SACD/CD示  
曲目號  
已播放曲目時間  
4
4
1 1 6  
曲目號  
剩餘曲目時間  
3 2 0  
剩餘碟片時間  
5 3 1 5  
Disc  
51  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
06  
觀看  
碟片  
JPEG  
6 章  
JPEG  
觀看  
碟片  
播放  
碟片  
JPEG  
裝入含JPEGCD/CD-R/RW按 從  
Loading  
按鈕不起作用。  
ZOOM  
當畫面顯示  
(正在裝載、  
碟片的第一個文件夾/第一張圖片開始逐張  
放機以字母順序顯示各文件夾中的圖  
片。  
ANGLE  
播放機載入一個文件的時間隨文件尺寸的  
增加而增加。  
播放機會自動調節圖片尺寸以盡可能使圖片  
充滿整個屏如果圖片的縱橫比與您的電  
視機屏幕不會發現屏幕左右或上下有黑  
。  
一張碟片上最多可有999個文件供觀。如  
果碟片上的文件數超過這個數目,則只有  
999文件可以觀看。  
逐張放映時︰  
使用 JPEG 碟片導向和圖片瀏覽  
按鈕  
功能  
暫停逐映,再次重開  
始。  
要通過文件名在處於播放位置的碟片上找到  
一個特定文件夾或圖片,請使用 JPEG 碟片導  
向;要通過縮略圖在文件夾中找到一張圖片,  
請使用圖片瀏覽器。  
顯示上一張圖片。  
顯示下一張圖片。  
ANGLE  
暫停逐映,並前顯的  
顯示碟片導向 (  
Disc  
)畫面。  
1
DVD MENU  
圖片順時針方向旋90°。按  
(播放)重新開始逐張放映。  
Navigator  
Disc Navigator  
ZOOM  
暫停逐張放映,放大畫面 (請參  
Folder 1-2  
File 1-40  
001. FL000001  
002. FL000002  
003. FL000003  
004. FL000004  
005. FL000005  
006. FL000006  
007. FL000007  
008. FL000008  
見下文按  
始逐張放映。  
(播放)重新開  
JPEG  
001. F_001  
002. F_002  
DVD  
MENU  
片導向畫參見下  
。  
FOLDER +/  
FOLDER –  
JPEG片時跳至下一/前一  
文件夾。  
左列顯示碟片上的文件列顯示文件夾中  
的文件。  
用光標按鈕 (  
)進行導向。  
ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ  
當一個文件被高亮顯示文件的縮略圖將  
2
顯示。  
52  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
06  
觀看  
碟片  
JPEG  
當一個文件夾亮顯示時,您可以按  
為該文件夾打開圖片瀏覽器畫面。  
在逐張放映播放時用  
1
大倍數。  
按鈕選擇放  
ZOOM  
ENTER  
關於圖片瀏覽器使用的更多資訊,請參見  
下文。  
(正常)  
Normal  
2x  
4x  
3
要從高亮顯示的 文件恢復逐張放映,按  
ENTER。  
使用圖片瀏覽器  
圖片瀏覽器從當前文件夾中一次顯示9張縮略  
圖。  
1
件夾目錄,然後按  
在碟片導向畫面中,高亮一個要顯示的文  
ENTER  
圖片瀏覽器畫面打9 圖片以縮略圖顯  
示。  
Photo Browser  
2 / 40 Live at Soft  
當屏幕畫面被放大時,逐張放映暫停。  
JPEG片的分辨率是固定像質  
量會有所下降,尤其是4放大時。但  
這不是故障。  
2
用光標按鈕(ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ)高亮顯示一幅  
縮略圖。  
用曲目跳躍按)觀看上一  
頁/下一頁的縮略圖。如果您想跳過若干  
頁,請按住按鈕不放直到您需要的那頁出  
現後再鬆開。  
用光標 按鈕 (  
)改變放 大區  
ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ  
2
域。  
您可以隨意改變放大倍數和放大區域。  
3
要恢復逐張放映,按 (播放)按鈕。  
要回到碟片導向畫面,按  
RETURN  
要以全尺寸在屏幕上顯示選定的縮略圖,  
3
ENTER  
從所選圖片恢復逐張放映。  
放大屏幕畫面  
當觀JPEG 碟片的圖片時,您能夠利用放大  
功能將畫面的一部分放2 4。  
53  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
07  
使用定時器  
7 章  
使用定時器  
選擇您要播放的播放源。  
:按 擇收音機作為您的播放。  
1
設置喚醒定時器  
使用喚醒定時器設置系統以在任何時候開啟  
TUNER  
電源並開始播放所需的播放源。  
準備播放源。  
2
例如:調諧喚醒時您所需的廣播電臺。  
3
4
設置音量。  
按兩次  
要使喚醒定時器正常工作,必須對時鐘進  
行準確的時間設請參見19設  
置時鐘。  
進入定時器選單。  
TIMER/CLOCK  
(左/右光標鈕選“  
Wake-  
5
ꢂ/ꢃ  
然後按  
ENTER  
Up?  
STANDBY/ON  
6
ꢂ/(左/右光標)按鈕選擇  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
TimerEdit?然後按 ENTER。  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
設置開啟時間。  
7
(上/下光標)按鈕設置小時,然後  
樣的方式設置分鐘,當您完  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
ENTER  
成設置後,按  
ENTER  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
TUNE+  
設置關閉時間。  
(上/下光標)按鈕設置小時,然後  
8
ST–  
ST+  
ENTER  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
TUNE–  
MUTE  
SOUND  
ENTER樣的方式設置分鐘,當您完  
成設置後,ENTER。  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
在最後一次按下 ENTER 之後,喚醒指示器亮  
示幕中對開關閉時功能(DVD/  
CD 等)以及音量進行了確認。  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
將系統切換至待機模式。  
9
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
如果系統保持開啟,則喚醒定時器將不起作  
用!  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
54  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
07  
使用定時器  
您可以通過按兩次  
在待機  
TIMER/CLOCK  
狀態中檢查定時器設按一次  
TIMER/  
將顯示當前時間。)  
CLOCK  
開啟/關閉喚醒定時器  
如果喚醒定時器處於開啟狀將每天在您  
所設置的時刻開啟系統。  
按兩次  
進入定時器選單。  
1
2
TIMER/CLOCK  
ꢂ/(左/右光標鈕選Wake-  
Up?然後按 ENTER。  
3
ꢂ/ꢃ  
Timer  
(左/右光標鈕選“  
On?  
Timer Off?  
”或 “  
”。  
您必須對定時器進行設請參見上文)  
ON  
以選擇  
。喚醒定時器將按照您先前的  
設置執行開啟或關閉操作。  
ENTER  
4
如果時鐘被復醒定時器將自動取。  
55  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
07  
使用定時器  
按兩次  
進入定時器選單。  
1
2
TIMER/CLOCK  
設置睡眠定時器  
在規定時間睡眠定時器將關閉系這樣  
ꢂ/(左/右光標)按鈕選擇  
Sleep?然後按 ENTER。  
您就無需擔心系統而安心入睡。  
3
間,然後按  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇關閉時  
ENTER  
在以下選項之間進行選擇:  
如果您在喚醒定時器開啟狀態下設置睡眠  
定時器,則較早的關閉時刻優先進行。  
-在當前 SACDCD、VCD超  
Sleep Auto  
VCDMP3片播放完畢之後,系統自  
動關閉。  
STANDBY/ON  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
-系統90鐘之後關閉。  
Sleep 90  
DVD  
TV  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
Sleep 60 -系統1 時之後關閉。  
Sleep 30 -系統30鐘之後關閉。  
Sleep Off  
-取消睡眠定時器。  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
要檢查剩餘時間長重複步驟 和 。  
1
4
將暫時顯示剩餘時間。  
2
ENTER  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
在VCDVCD進行PBC播放  
Sleep Auto  
TV CONTROL  
期間,或者CD複播放期間不起作。  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
56  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
08  
環繞聲設定  
8 章  
環繞聲設定  
設定環繞聲  
房間設定功(第20)設計用於帶給您一  
個基本的環繞聲設是您仍可以進行更詳  
細的設置,以改善您收聽房間內的環繞聲。  
當您改變揚聲器距離和聲道音壓設定時,  
這些設定將覆蓋您在房間設定中所作的設  
定。  
STANDBY/ON  
1
2
SYSTEM SETUP  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
ꢂ/ꢃ (左/右光標)按鈕選擇您要進  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
行調節的設置。  
當您瀏覽顯示幕時,將顯示各選項的當前設  
置。請參見下文的各設置的完整列表和說明。  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
(上/下光標)按鈕調節設置。  
3
4
5
ꢀ/ꢁ  
重複步驟  
進行其它設置。  
2
3
ENTER  
MUTE  
SOUND  
當您完成設置ENTER 離開系統設  
定選單。  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
如果在5分鐘之內不進行操統設置選  
BASS MODE DIALOGUE  
VIRTUAL SB  
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
單將自動退出。  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
3
系統設定選單選項  
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
4
以下是設定選單中的所有可選設部分的  
第一個設置為預設狀態。有關設置的附加資  
訊,請同樣參見各章節中的注意事項。  
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
57  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
08  
環繞聲設定  
前置揚聲器距離設置  
指定從您的收聽位置到前置揚聲器的距離:  
雙重單聲道設置  
對以雙重單聲道編碼的杜比數位或DTS軌指  
定播放方式。 您還可以使用該設置對錄有二  
個獨立音軌DVD-RW片進行聲道的切換。  
Front 0.3 m Front 9 m-可0.3 m為  
增量進行距離設置。預設狀態3 m。  
L-Ch1 R-Ch2 -兩個聲道均通過前置揚聲  
器進行播放  
中置揚聲器距離設置  
指定從您的收聽位置到中置揚聲器的距離:  
Ch1 Mono -僅播放聲1  
Center 0.3 m  
Center 9 m  
-可0.3 m  
Ch2 Mono  
-僅播放聲2  
為增量進行距離設置。預設狀態3 m。  
環繞聲揚聲器距離設置  
指定從您的收聽位置到前置揚聲器的距離:  
Ch1 Mono Ch2 Mono 設置音  
僅從中置揚聲器中傳如果STEREO  
模式收聽,則從前置揚聲器中傳出。  
Surr. 0.3 m  
Surr. 9 m  
-可0.3 m為  
增量進行距離設置。預設狀態3 m。  
該設置僅對以雙重單聲道編碼的杜比數位  
DTS軌有效。有關聲道的資訊,請參  
見碟片封套。  
動態範圍控制  
對杜比數位DTS音軌指定動態範圍的調節幅  
度:  
-無動態範圍調節(當以較高音  
LFE 衰減器設置  
DRC Off  
量進行收聽時使用)  
杜比數位和 DTS 音頻播放源包括了超低音音  
調請按需要設LFE減器以防止超低音出  
現聲音失真。  
-中等設置  
DRC Mid  
-動態範圍降較響的聲音  
DRC High  
音量降低而較安靜的聲音音量增加)  
-LFE聲道以無衰減狀態進行播  
LFE ATT 0  
LFE10dB行衰減  
LFE ATT 10  
-不播LFE道  
LFE Off  
該設置僅對杜比數位和某些DTS音軌有。  
對於其它播放源,您可以通過使用午夜模  
請參見34 使用安靜和午夜聽  
音模式)創造類似的效果。  
58  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
08  
環繞聲設定  
將遙控器切換至  
收聽測試音。  
後按  
SUB  
2
TEST TONE  
設置聲道等級  
您可以為各收聽模式設置與您的主要收聽位  
置相關的聲道等中包括所有的環繞聲以  
及高級環繞聲模式。  
測試音將按以下順序輸按當前收聽模式  
從開啟的揚聲器中傳出:  
L -前置左揚聲器  
如果您使用房間設定功20 頁則各  
收聽模式的聲道等級將隨即被設但是您  
仍可以按需要對各等級進行微調。  
C -中置揚聲器  
R  
-前置右揚聲器  
-右環繞聲揚聲器  
RS  
LS  
SW  
STANDBY/ON  
-左環繞聲揚聲器  
CD  
FM/AM  
TUNER  
L1/L2  
LINE  
DVD  
TV  
-超低音揚聲器  
DISPLAY  
OPEN CLOSE  
3
MASTER VOLUME+/- 按鈕將音量調節  
至適當等級。  
DVD MENU  
RETURN  
4
聲器等級。  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
(上/下光標)按鈕依次調節揚  
ENTER  
當您坐在主要收聽位置上應該可以同樣  
的音量聽到各揚聲器中傳出的測試道的  
等級範圍為±10 dB。  
MUTE  
SOUND  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
TV CONTROL  
當您完成設置按  
5
設定。  
退出測試音  
ENTER  
CH  
INPUT  
VOL  
BASS MODE 
AUTO  
SURROUND ADVANCED  
PROGRAM  
AUDIO  
REPEAT  
RANDOM  
ANGLE  
SUBTITLE  
HOME  
MENU  
ZOOM  
1
TOP MENU  
2
通過按  
,然後用  
CH LEVEL  
(上/下  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
3
SYSTEM  
TESTTONE  
5
CH LEVEL  
6
SETUP  
光標)按鈕調節聲道等級,可在收聽任何  
所需聲音播放源時對器音量進行調  
節。當您完成了一個聲道的設置之後,請  
4
QUIET/  
TIMER/  
DIMMER  
7
MIDNIGHT  
CLOCK  
8
9
FOLDER–  
0
FOLDER+  
ENTER  
CLR  
ROOM SETUP  
MAIN  
SUB  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
置。  
(左/右光標)按鈕移至下一設  
反覆按  
1
收聽模式。  
選擇  
ADVANCED  
SURROUND  
超低音揚聲器可產生超低頻率,因此其聲  
音聽上去比實際的聲音要更為安靜。  
59  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
09  
視頻調節  
選單  
(Video Adjust)  
9 章  
(Video Adjust)  
創建您自己的預設項  
視頻調節  
選單  
視頻調節  
預設狀態︰  
(Video Adjust)  
您最多創建二個您自己的預設項。  
Standard  
從視頻調節畫面您可以選擇標準視頻顯示或  
者定義您自己的預設項。  
選擇一個記憶預設項 (請參見上文。  
1
2
Detailed Settings  
(下光標“  
1
HOME MENU 從螢幕顯示選Video  
ENTER  
(詳細設置再按  
Adjust視頻調節。  
Video Adjust  
Memory1  
HOME MENU  
DVD  
Detailed Settings  
Play Mode  
Video Adjust  
3
調節圖像質量設置值。  
Disc Navigator  
Initial Settings  
Memory1  
Recall Settings  
Contrast  
Memory1  
min  
min  
min  
max  
max  
max  
Brightness  
2
設項。  
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇一個預  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
Chroma Level  
Video Adjust  
Standard  
(上/下光標鈕選擇一個設置  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
項。  
(左/右光標)按鈕調節當前設  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
標準-普通  
置。  
(記憶  
-用於保存您自  
1-2  
Memory1-2  
己的預設請參見下文)  
DISPLAY 在全部顯示和單個顯示間切  
換。  
完成設置,退出  
Video Adjust  
3
ENTER  
(視頻調節)畫面。  
您可以通過 Recall Settings (調用設置)  
選單項改變預設項號碼。  
根據碟片和電視機/監視器的類型,您可  
能無法看到明顯的效果。  
60  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
09  
視頻調節  
選單  
(Video Adjust)  
您可以調節下列任一或全部圖像質量設置:  
(對比度) -在亮暗間調節對比  
Contrast  
度。  
Brightness (亮度)-調節整體亮度。  
Chroma Level  
的飽和程度。  
(色度水平)-調節顏色  
ENTER  
保存預設退出視頻調節畫。  
4
61  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
10 章  
(Initial Settings)  
初始設置  
選單  
Digital Audio Mode Settings  
(數位音頻模式設定)  
如果您將外接的數位設備連接至光學數位輸  
使用初始設置  
選單  
初始設置選單讓您能夠完全掌控DVD統的設  
(Initial Settings)  
其中包括視頻輸出設置項,家長鎖定設置 出,則請進行這些設定。請注意,DVD碟和  
項等。  
SACD音頻並非通過該光學插孔輸出。  
如果某個選項呈灰明此時該選項無法改  
通常這是因為有碟片正在播放。請停止該  
碟片的播放,然後改變設置。  
Dolby Digital Out  
(杜比數位輸出)  
預設狀態Dolby Digital  
1
HOME MENU,從螢幕顯示中選定  
Initial Settings  
Initial Settings初始設置。  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Dolby Digital Out  
DTS Out  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital > PCM  
Linear PCM Out  
HOME MENU  
DVD  
Display  
Options  
Play Mode  
Video Adjust  
Disc Navigator  
Initial Settings  
如果所連接的設備為杜比數位兼將本設  
定設為  
(杜比數位,否則設  
。如果您不確定該設  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital >PCM  
備是否為杜比數位兼查看隨該設備附帶  
的手冊。  
從左列選定設置類別,然後從右列中選定  
2
項目。  
進行您所要的設置。  
3
DTS Out DTS  
輸出)  
DTS  
預設狀態︰  
Initial Settings  
下文螢幕顯示圖例中顯示的語言選項可能  
與用於貴國或貴地區的語言不同。  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Dolby Digital Out  
DTS Out  
DTS  
DTS > PCM  
Linear PCM Out  
Display  
Options  
62  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
如果所連接的設備具有內置DTS,請  
將本設定設為 ,否則設為 。如  
Video Output settings (視頻  
輸出設置)  
DTS DTS>PCM  
果您不確定該設備是否DTS查看隨  
該設備附帶的手冊。  
TV Screen TV  
屏幕)  
16:9 (Wide)  
預設狀態︰  
Initial Settings  
如果對於非DTS兼容設將本設定設為  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
4:3 (Letter Box)  
4:3 (Pan&Scan)  
16:9 (Wide)  
TV Screen  
,則當您播DTS片時將輸出噪  
DTS  
Component Out  
S-Video Out  
音。  
Display  
Options  
無論本設定為DTS-CD始終輸出DTS數位  
音頻。  
如果您的電視機是寬屏16:9 (Wide)  
(寬屏﹞  
Linear PCM Out  
PCM  
輸出)  
(線性  
Down Sample Off  
16:9  
設定-寬屏 DVD 軟體將用全  
預設狀態︰  
屏進行顯示。在播放以傳4:3)格式錄製  
的軟體時,您電視機上的設置將決定畫面以何  
種方式呈現-關於哪些選項可用的詳細資訊,  
請參見您電視機附帶的說明書。  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Dolby Digital Out  
DTS Out  
Down Sample On  
Down Sample Off  
Linear PCM Out  
Display  
如果您的電視機是傳統4:3 (Letter  
Options  
(信箱或  
4:3 (Pan & Scan) 4:3  
Box) 4:3  
(全景掃描。在信箱模式下,寬屏軟體在  
屏幕頂部和底部顯示有黑全景掃描將削  
去寬屏畫面的兩使其適4:3因  
此盡管屏幕上的影像看上去大實際上您  
看到的圖像內容比原來少了同時請參見第  
87屏幕尺寸和碟片格式。  
如果所連接的設備與高取樣96 kHz)兼  
容,請將本設定設Down Sample Off,否  
則設Down Sample On (96 kHz 音頻轉  
換為更為兼容48 kHz如果您不確定該  
設備是否96 kHz容,請查看隨該設備附  
帶的手冊。  
即使本設定設為  
些  
Down Sample Off  
碟片仍將通過數位輸出端輸出向下取樣的  
音頻(您僅能通過模擬輸出端獲取全取樣  
率的音頻。  
63  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
如果您連電視機不兼容逐行掃描信  
號,卻將播放機切換為逐行模式,您將完  
全看不到圖像。在這種情況下,請按  
(分量輸出)  
Component Out  
僅本系統通過分量視頻輸出與電視機連接時,  
才需要進行這項設置。  
將系統切換至待機,然後  
STANDBY/ON  
預設狀態︰  
Interlace  
按住前面板上的 (停止 8鐘直  
至顯示幕上出現  
。按住前面板  
Mem.Clr.?  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
上的  
按鈕,顯示幕現  
VOL–  
+
。按住前面板上的  
TV Screen  
Progressive  
Interlace  
Component Out  
S-Video Out  
按鈕設  
Interlace?  
Display  
為逐行且重新打開本機。  
Options  
本系統對逐行掃描電視機的兼容性  
本機與帶 Macro Vision統拷貝保護技術的  
逐行掃描視頻兼容。  
描,請設定為  
Progressive  
(逐行)以獲得無閃爍的視頻輸  
出。如果您的電視機不兼容逐行掃描視頻信  
Interlace  
消費者請務必注意,並非所有的高清晰度電視機完全  
兼容本產品,可能導致圖像中有異常信號顯示。如果  
號,則請設定為  
(隔行。如果您  
525  
逐行掃描圖像出現問題,我們建議用戶將連接切  
換到 “標準清晰度STANDARD DEFINITION)輸  
出。如果有關於我公司電視機與本 播放機  
無法確定您電視機的兼容查看電視機附  
帶的說明書。  
525p DVD  
兼容性的問題,請與我們的客戶服務中心聯繫。  
︰  
PDP-503HDG,PDP-433HDG 逐行掃描兼容電視  
機。  
如果設定為  
按一次  
(逐行,您必須多  
)。關於  
RETURN  
Progressive  
(或按  
ENTER  
逐行掃描視頻的重要資訊請同時參見下文。  
關於逐行掃描視頻  
相較於隔行掃描視行掃描視頻的圖像掃  
描率提高了一倍,這樣生成的圖像極為穩定,  
毫無閃行掃描視頻僅通過分量視頻輸出  
才能獲得。  
參見上為  
Progressive 時,VIDEO S-  
插孔無視頻信號輸果您想同  
VIDEO  
時在幾個監視器上顯示視頻信號,請確認  
該項目被設定Interlace (隔行。  
64  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
( 視頻輸出)  
S
S-Video Out  
僅當本系統S頻電纜與您的電視機連接  
時,才需要進行這項設置。  
您可以在播放過程中用  
按鈕DVD  
AUDIO  
影碟上所錄語言之間進行切換這不影  
響本設置。)請參見第 48 切換 DVD  
影碟伴音語言。  
預設狀態︰  
S2  
Initial Settings  
DVD碟在裝入時會忽略  
Audio  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
TV Screen  
S1  
S2  
Component Out  
S-Video Out  
(伴音語言)設置,自動設定  
Language  
伴音語言。  
Display  
Options  
帶有兩種以上伴音語言的碟片一般可從碟  
片選單選擇伴音語言。要進入碟片選單,  
DVD MENU 按鈕。  
如果您發現在預設狀態  
下圖像有拉伸  
S2  
或扭曲,請嘗試將設置改為 。  
S1  
(字幕語言)  
Subtitle Language  
預設狀態︰  
English  
(語言設  
Language settings  
置)  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Audio Language  
Subtitle Language  
DVD Menu Lang.  
Subtitle Display  
English  
Audio Language (伴音語言)  
French  
Spanish  
預設狀態︰  
English  
Display  
Chinese  
Options  
Other Language  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Audio Language  
Subtitle Language  
DVD Menu Lang.  
Subtitle Display  
English  
French  
本設置項設定您首選DVD碟字幕語。如  
果碟片上錄製有您在此處指定的語播放  
機將自動以該語言字幕播放碟片。  
Spanish  
Display  
Chinese  
Options  
Other Language  
DVD碟格式能夠識136不同的語如  
果您想指定一種未在列表中列出的語選  
Other Language (其他語言。請參見第  
87使用語言代碼列表選擇語言。  
本設置項設定您首選DVD碟伴音語。如  
果碟片上錄製有您在此處指定的語系統  
將自動以該語言播放碟片。  
DVD碟格式能夠識136不同的語言。如  
果您想指定一種未在列表中列出的語選  
(其他語言。請同時參  
Other Language  
87使用語言代碼列表選擇語言。  
65  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
(字幕顯示)  
Subtitle Display  
預設狀態︰  
On  
您可以在播放過程中用  
按鈕改  
SUBTITLE  
Initial Settings  
變或關閉 DVD 影碟上的字幕這不影響  
本設置。)請參47切換字幕。  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Audio Language  
Subtitle Language  
DVD Menu Lang.  
Subtitle Display  
On  
Off  
DVD碟在裝入時會忽略  
Subtitle  
Display  
Options  
(字幕語言)設置,自動設定  
Language  
字幕語言。  
帶有兩種以上字幕語言的碟片一般可從碟  
片選單選擇字幕語言。要進入碟片選單,  
DVD MENU 按鈕。  
當設On放機根Subtitle Language  
(字幕語言)設置顯示字設定Off 則關  
閉全部字幕。  
DVD Menu Language DVD  
言)  
選單語  
Display settings  
(顯示設置)  
預設狀態︰  
w/Subtitle Lang.  
OSD Language OSD  
語言)  
Initial Settings  
預設狀態︰  
English  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Audio Language  
Subtitle Language  
DVD Menu Lang.  
Subtitle Display  
w/Subtitle Lang.  
English  
French  
Initial Settings  
Display  
Spanish  
Chinese  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
OSD Language  
On Screen Display  
Angle Indicator  
English  
fran ais  
Español  
Options  
Other Language  
Display  
Options  
一些多語種碟片具有多種語言的碟片選。本  
設置項指定碟片選單的顯示語留預設狀  
本設置項設定播放機的螢幕顯示語言。  
Subtitle Language  
言)請參見上文)相同的語言顯示。  
選單將以與  
(字幕語  
(螢幕顯示)  
On Screen Display  
DVD碟格式能夠識136不同的語言。如  
果您想指定一種未在列表中列出的語選  
預設狀態︰  
On  
(其他語言。請參見第  
Other Language  
Initial Settings  
87使用語言代碼列表選擇語言。  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
OSD Language  
On Screen Display  
Angle Indicator  
On  
Off  
Display  
Options  
66  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
設定操作顯示是否在螢出現  
(播放(恢復(掃  
Play  
描)。  
Resume Scan  
並非所有您認為不適合於孩子觀看的碟片  
都具有家長鎖定功能。這些碟片不需要輸  
入密碼就能播放。  
Angle Indicator  
(角度指示器)  
On  
預設狀態︰  
如果您忘記了密碼,則需要將播放機重置  
為工廠設請參見77重置本系  
然後登錄一個新密碼。  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
OSD Language  
On Screen Display  
Angle Indicator  
On  
Off  
登錄一個新密碼  
在您改變家長鎖定級別或輸入國家代碼,您  
必須先登錄一個密碼。  
Display  
Options  
1
選定 “Password密碼。  
如果您不想在播放DVD片的多視角畫面時在  
屏幕上看見攝影機圖將本設置改Off。  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Password  
Bonus Group  
Level Change  
Country Code  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Options (選項)  
Display  
Options  
Parental Lock  
(家長鎖定)  
默認級別Off  
用數字按鈕輸入一個 位數密碼。  
4
2
默認密碼︰無  
Initial Settings  
默認國家代碼︰  
us 2119  
DVD碟有家長鎖定級別果您的播放  
機設定的級別較碟片碟片將無法播放這  
樣,就可以適當控制孩子DVD統中的觀  
看內容。  
Digital Audio Mode  
Parental Lock: Register Code Number  
Video Output  
Language  
*
*
*
*
Display  
Options  
一些碟片還支持國家代碼功據您所設定  
的國家代放機將不播放這些碟片上的某  
些畫面。  
您輸入的數字在螢幕上以星*)顯示。  
在設定家長鎖定級別或國家代碼必須先  
登錄一個密作為密碼擁有者可以隨時  
改變家長鎖定級別或國家代也能改變密  
碼。  
67  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
3
面。  
登錄該密碼並回到選項選單畫  
4
面。  
登錄新密碼並回到選項選單畫  
ENTER  
ENTER  
如果您忘記了密可以重置播放機後登  
錄一個新密關於如何重置播放機參見  
第77重置本系統。  
設置/改變家長鎖定級別  
1
2
3
選定 “Level Change改變級別。  
改變您的密碼  
要改變您的密碼先確認您當前的密碼再  
輸入一個新密碼。  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Password Change  
Level Change  
Bonus Group  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Country Code  
Display  
1
Password Change改變密碼。  
Options  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Password Change  
Level Change  
用數字按鈕輸入您的密碼,再按  
ENTER  
Bonus Group  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Country Code  
Display  
Initial Settings  
Options  
Parental Lock : Level Change  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Display  
Password  
*
*
*
*
用 數 字按 鈕 輸 入 您當 前 的 密 碼,再按  
2
Options  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
off  
ENTER  
當您輸入數字時,它們以星號顯示。  
選擇一個新的級別。  
Initial Settings  
Parental Lock: Password Change  
Digital Audio Mode  
Initial Settings  
Video Output  
Password  
*
*
*
*
Parental Lock : Level Change  
Password  
Language  
Display  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
*
*
*
*
New Password  
Options  
Display  
Options  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
off  
輸入一個新的密碼。  
3
反覆(左光標)鎖住更多級別(更多的  
碟片需要密碼(右光標)解鎖級。  
您無法鎖定級1。  
Initial Settings  
Parental Lock: Password Change  
Password  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
設定新的級別並回到選項選單畫  
ENTER  
Display  
4
面。  
New Password  
Options  
68  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
通過代碼數字進行選擇︰按  
(右光  
設置/改變國家代碼  
您可能需要參見88()代  
碼列表。  
然後用數字按鈕輸入 4 位數的國家  
您可以參見88 頁“(區  
) 代碼列表。)  
1
2
3
選定 “Country Code國家代碼。  
Initial Settings  
Initial Settings  
Parental Lock: Country Code  
Digital Audio Mode  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Password Change  
Level Change  
Video Output  
Language  
Display  
Password  
*
*
*
*
Bonus Group  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Country Code  
Country Code List  
us  
Code  
Display  
Options  
2
1
1
9
Options  
設定新的國家代碼並回到選項選  
4 ENTER  
單畫面。  
用數字按鈕輸入您的密碼,再按  
ENTER  
Initial Settings  
Parental Lock Change: Country Code  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Display  
Password  
*
*
*
*
對國家代碼設置的變更直到下一張碟片裝  
或當前碟片重裝)後才生效。  
Country Code List  
us  
Code  
Options  
2
1
1
9
Bonus Group (附送類)  
選擇一個國家代碼。  
有兩種方法可選擇國家代碼。  
Initial Settings  
通過代碼字母進行選擇︰用  
(上/下  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
Off (us)  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
光標)改變國家代碼。  
On  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Single  
Display  
DVD-Audio  
2ch Area  
Options  
Initial Settings  
Parental Lock: Country Code  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Display  
Password  
*
*
*
*
某些 DVD 唱碟具有額外附送”類,該類  
4數密關詳情和密碼請參見碟片  
包裝。  
Country Code List  
us  
Code  
Options  
2
1
1
9
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Bonus Group : Key Number Input  
Video Output  
Language  
_
_
_
_
Display  
Options  
69  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
當您播放具有附送類DVD碼輸入  
畫面將自動顯示。您也可以在此處進入該畫  
面。  
(分組播放)  
Single  
Group Playback  
預設狀態︰  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
All  
Single  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Display  
如果您退出碟片、關閉電源或拔下播放機  
的電源線,則需要重新輸入密碼。  
Options  
Auto Disc Menu  
(自動碟片選單)  
DVD碟可具有多9分組的曲目。當本設  
定設Single(單組,所選的分組播放,然  
後碟片停止,或者返回到選單畫面使用搜  
索功第 47 頁)選擇要播放的分組在  
本模式不能使用曲目跳躍 /或  
掃描按/。)  
預設狀態On  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
On  
Off  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Display  
Options  
如果您要連續播放碟片上的所有分設為  
All  
(全部。  
該設定指定碟片裝入後選頂層選單)是  
否自動顯示果您想要選單自動顯示,設為  
,或者如果您不想要其顯示,設為  
Off  
On  
即使本播放機被設為 All (全部)但若您  
從碟片選選擇了一個分組以進行播  
僅該分組將播果您停止播,  
則當您重新開始播放時,所有分組將再次  
播放。  
對於某DVD論該設定為將  
自動顯示選果您在碟片裝入時按 ,  
本設定將被忽略。  
DVD Playback Mode DVD  
式)  
模  
預設狀態DVD-Audio  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
DVD-Audio  
DVD-Video  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Display  
Options  
70  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
初始設置  
選單  
(Initial Settings)  
DVDDVD頻外還包DVD頻內  
容。將本設定設DVD-VideoDVD頻)可  
DVD碟那樣播放 DVD碟。請注此  
時,僅碟片DVD頻部分進行播放。  
(圖片瀏覽器)  
On  
PhotoViewer  
預設狀態︰  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
On  
Off  
Bonus Group  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
Display  
Options  
當功能改變、碟片托盤被打開或者電源被  
切換至待機模式設定將轉換DVD-  
AudioDVD。  
如果您裝入的碟片同時包括 MP3 音頻文件和  
JPEG片文件,則該項設置就十分重要。  
SACD Playback SACD  
播放)  
On  
文件。設定為  
預設狀態  
使您僅能觀看此類碟片上的JPEG  
Off  
預設狀態Multi-ch Area  
將能夠播MP3頻文件。  
Initial Settings  
Digital Audio Mode  
Video Output  
Language  
Parental Lock  
Bonus Group  
2ch Area  
Multi-ch Area  
CD Area  
Auto Disc Menu  
Group Playback  
DVD Playback Mode  
SACD Playback  
Photo Viewer  
對圖片瀏覽器設置的變更直到下一張碟片  
或當前碟片重裝)後才生效。  
Display  
Options  
SACD 碟片可以被分為多個不同的區域-立體  
聲音多聲(  
2ch Area  
於雙層 SACD 的標準 CD 音頻  
Multi-  
ch Area  
請選擇您要收聽的部分。  
CD Area  
如果裝入的碟片上沒有您選擇的區域,則  
將播放其他區域。例如,如果您選擇標準  
CD頻,但所裝入的碟片不是雙SACD,  
則將播放立體SACD域。  
71  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
其它連接  
11 章  
其它連接  
連接外接天線  
連接輔助設備  
該系統兼備立體聲模擬輸入與輸出具備  
一個光學數位輸入端和一個光學數位輸出端。  
請使用這些端子連接外接設如您VCR,  
MDCD-R製機。  
AM  
請使用5-6米的乙烯絕緣電線並在室內或室外  
外接  
天線  
進行安裝。保AM形天線的連接。  
插孔連接至您電視或  
音  
VCR  
頻輸出端。  
TV  
這使您能通過本系統來收聽電視VCR。  
請使RCA插頭的立體聲電纜進行連。請  
同樣參見73降低電視機和線路信號電  
。  
ENNA  
5–6 m  
BAL AM LOOP  
ANTENNA  
外接 FM 天線  
請使用一75 同軸電纜鉤住外接 FM線。  
AUDIO  
OUTPUT  
LINE1  
VIDEO  
OUT  
S-VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
ATENNA  
AUDIO  
LINE1  
OUT  
TV  
IN  
LINE1  
IN  
LINE2  
IN  
FM UNBAL AM LOOP  
75  
ANTENNA  
XV–DV900/XV–DV700  
72  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
其它連接  
)插孔連接至外部播放設備  
將後面板上的  
)插 孔  
的模擬輸出端。  
LINE1 IN  
LINE1 OPTICAL IN  
連接至外部播放設備的光學數位輸出端。  
其中包括諸VCR錄音機之類的設備使  
RCA插頭的立體聲電纜進行連同樣  
參見下降低電視機和線路信號電平。  
OPT  
ICAL  
DIGIT  
AL  
IN  
LINE  
1
LINE 1OUT孔連接至外部錄音設  
備的模擬輸入端。  
其中包括諸如錄音機、VCR、MD具有模擬輸  
入端的其它錄製使RCA插頭的立體  
聲電纜進行連接。  
其中包括諸如 MD放機,數位衛星或遊戲系  
統之類的數位設使用光學數位電纜(未  
隨機提供)進行連接。  
降低電視機和線路信號電平  
預設狀態:  
ATT 6dB  
AUDIO  
INPUT  
AUDIO  
OUTPUT  
某些播放源可能產生很高的信號等可能  
引起揚聲器發出難聽的聲音失這種情況  
下,可能需要通過開啟衰減器來降低輔助播  
所連接的  
模擬  
LINE2  
TV  
LINE1  
輸入)的信號等級。  
將系統切換至待機狀態。  
1
2
3
CAL  
TAL  
SYSTEM SETUP。  
N
LINE1  
VIDEO  
OUT  
S-VIDEO  
OUT  
O  
L
L
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇 “  
TV  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
”或 “ ”或 “  
LINE1 ATT? LINE2 ATT?  
AUDIO  
AUD  
R
R
”,  
LINE1  
OUT  
ATT?  
然後按  
TV  
IN  
LINE1  
IN  
LINE2  
IN  
ENTER  
XV-DV900/XV-DV700  
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇 “  
4
ꢀ/ꢁ  
ATT  
“  
”或 “  
”。  
Off  
ATT 6dB ATT 10dB  
將後面板上的 OPTICAL DIGITAL OUT 插  
孔連接至外部錄音設備的光學數位輸入端。  
如果 ATT 6dB 設置仍然導致聲音失真,請嘗  
ATT 10dB 設置。  
OPTICAL  
5
ENTER 進行確認。  
DIGIT  
AL  
OUT  
73  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
其它連接  
錄音模式  
錄音模式讓您能夠通過  
使用 S 視頻輸出端進行連接  
如果您的電視機帶S頻輸入您可以  
使用該輸入端來代替標準視頻信號輸出,以  
獲得質量更好的圖像。  
插孔  
LINE1 OUT  
進行模擬錄音。  
當開啟錄音模式多數與聲音相關的功能  
(包括 SURROUNDADVANCEDAUTO,  
SYSTEM SETUP處於未啟用狀果您  
S
S-VIDEO  
使用 視頻電未隨機提供將  
OUT  
S
連接至您電視機上的 視頻輸入端。  
試圖在錄音模式開啟時使用某一被禁功,則  
顯示幕將簡短閃RecMode On。  
在插入電纜之將插孔上方的小三角對準  
插頭上的小三角。  
當錄音模式關閉模擬輸出端傳出的音頻  
可能被中斷,這取決於操作本身。  
1
2
SOUND  
S-VIDEO  
INPUT  
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇 “  
Rec  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
”。  
Mode?  
3
ENTER。  
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇  
4
ꢀ/ꢁ  
”或 “  
R.Mode On  
”。  
R.Mode Off  
ANTENNA  
On  
DVD唱碟和  
當錄音模式設為  
E1  
VIDEO  
OUT  
S-VIDEO  
OUT  
SACD碟片的向下混合立體聲從揚聲器和模  
擬音頻插口輸. 注意,對於某DVD  
VIDEO  
AM  
L
ANTE  
L
AUDIO  
PR  
PB  
Y
R
NE1  
UT  
Off  
前置左/右聲道輸設為  
TV  
IN  
LINE1  
IN  
LINE2  
IN  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO OUT  
DVDSACD片通過所有  
揚聲器播放,但前置左/右音頻從模擬音  
頻插口輸出。  
XV-DV900/XV-DV700  
在播放SACD若選擇  
機將  
R.Mode On  
端開揚聲器SW輸音將變得無法聽。  
S視頻輸出端可S1S2格式之間進行切  
換以和所有電視機兼關其詳細說,  
請參見65頁S-Video OutS頻輸  
。  
74  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
其它連接  
使用設備視頻輸出進行連接  
如果您的電視機帶有設備視頻輸入您可  
以使用這些輸入端來代替標準視頻信號輸出  
以將本系連接至您的電視機三種可選  
的視頻輸出方式會給您帶來最佳的圖像  
質量。  
使 用設 備 視 頻 電 纜 (未 隨 機提 供)將  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
上的一組份量輸入端。  
連接至您電視機  
COMPONENT  
INPUT  
ANTENNA  
FBAL LOOP  
TENNA  
AUDIO  
E1  
LINE2  
IN  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO OUT  
N
XV-DV900/XV-DV700  
份量視頻輸出端可在隔行掃描格式和逐行  
格式之間進行切換。有關其詳細說明,請  
參見第 64 Component Out分量輸  
。  
75  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
12 章  
附加資訊  
進行確認。  
ENTER  
5
關閉演示  
預設狀態:  
Demo On  
該系統具有自動演示功系統第一次接通 改變時鐘格式  
12-Hour  
電源時,該功能開始運行。  
預設狀態:  
您可以選1224 小時格式的時鐘顯示。  
1
2
3
將系統切換至待機狀態。  
將系統切換至待機狀態。  
1
2
3
SYSTEM SETUP  
SYSTEM SETUP。  
(左/右光標鈕選“  
ꢂ/ꢃ Demo  
然後按  
Mode?  
ENTER  
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇 “  
12/  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
然後按  
24 Hour?  
ENTER  
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇 “  
12-  
4
ꢀ/ꢁ(上/下光標鈕選擇“Demo  
Off?然後按 ENTER 進行確認。  
4
ꢀ/ꢁ  
”或 “  
Hour?  
”。  
24-Hour?  
5
ENTER 進行確認。  
在設置時鐘之後,演示模式自動關閉。但  
是,如果您從電源插座上斷開系統電源,  
演示模式將返Demo On (且時鐘將被  
改變頻率等級  
預設狀態:FM 100 AM 10  
復位。  
如果發現您無法成功地調諧電該頻率等  
級可能不適合您所在的國家/地區。  
童鎖  
將系統切換至待機狀態。  
1
2
3
預設狀態:  
Lock Off  
SYSTEM SETUP  
該系統具有童鎖功使前面板按鈕和控制  
按鈕失去作用。  
ꢂ/ꢃ (左/右光標)按鈕選擇 “FM  
AM Step?然後按 ENTER。  
1
2
將系統切換至待機狀態。  
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇 “  
4
ꢀ/ꢁ  
FM  
然後按  
SYSTEM SETUP  
”或 “  
50 AM 9?  
FM100 AM 10?  
進行確認。  
(左/右光標)按鈕選“  
Child  
3
ꢂ/ꢃ  
ENTER  
然後按  
ENTER  
Lock?  
4
ꢀ/(上/下光標)按鈕選擇 “Lock  
On?”或 “Lock Off?。  
76  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
設置電視制式  
預設狀態:  
PAL 制電視機 (MOD.PAL)  
AUTO  
上觀看 NTSC 節目  
本系統的預設狀態AUTO非您在播放某  
多數採用新開發的分頻PAL視制式的電  
視機能夠檢50 HzPAL)/60 HzNTSC)  
信號,並自動切換垂直幅度,從而生成垂直  
方向無收縮的圖像。然而,在某些情況下,  
圖像無色。  
些碟片時發現圖像有失則最好讓其保持  
AUTO 預設狀果對於某些碟片圖像出現  
請設置電視制式與您所在國家或地  
區採用的制式相而這樣做可能會限制某  
些碟片的觀表表明了各個設AUTO、  
PAL NTSC)與哪些碟片兼容。  
如果您PAL視機沒V-Hold垂直保持)  
控制功能,則由於圖像滾動您可能無法觀看  
NTSC果電視機帶V-Hold制功,  
請對其進行調節直至圖像停止滾動。  
1
2
3
將系統切換至待機狀態。  
SYSTEM SETUP  
在某些電視機上,圖像可能會垂直收在屏  
幕頂部和底部留下黑這不是故障,而是由  
NTSCPAL轉換造成的。  
(左/右光標) 按鈕選擇 “  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
然後按  
TV  
ENTER  
System?  
ꢀ/ꢁ (上/下光標)按鈕選擇 Auto、  
PAL NTSC 然後按 ENTER 進行確認。  
4
重置本系統  
通過下述步系統的所有設(臺記憶  
)重置為工廠預設狀態。  
碟片  
播放機設置  
1
2
將播放機切換到待機狀態。  
按住前面板上的 (停止鈕大約  
格式  
NTSC  
PAL  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
PAL  
AUTO  
類型  
DVD  
MOD.PAL NTSC  
8
鐘直至顯示幕上出現 “  
”。  
Mem.Clr.?  
PAL  
PAL  
Video CD NTSC  
PAL  
MOD.PAL NTSC  
按前面板上的  
按鈕。  
3
現在播放機的所有設置值都已被重將能  
夠看Welcome to Pioneer DVD!(迎使  
用先DVD!)”畫面。  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
NTSC  
CD /無碟  
NTSC  
PAL  
調節顯示幕亮度  
預設狀態︰  
3
本顯示幕具有三個亮度級1-3。  
DIMMER 改變顯示幕的亮度級別。  
1
77  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
影碟區域  
DVD  
使用和保護碟片  
DVD影碟都在其碟片盒的某處印有區域標  
誌,個標誌指明該碟片與世界上的哪些地區  
兼容DVD統也有一個區域標誌可  
以在後面板上找到自非兼容區域的碟片  
標題,章和曲目  
DVD片一般被劃分為一個或多個標題。標題  
可被進一步細分為章。  
無法在本播放機上播放。標有  
(所有區  
ALL  
域)的碟片可以在任意一臺播放機上播放。  
下圖顯示全世界的各DVD域。  
DVD碟一般被劃分為一個或多個每個組  
可能包括許多曲目。  
CD、SACDVCDVCD劃分為曲目。  
CD-ROM括文件夾和文MP3件被稱為曲  
目。文件夾可能包括下一級文件夾。  
78  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
拿取碟片 存儲碟片  
拿取碟片時,注意不要在碟片表面留下指印, 雖然 CDDVD片比乙烯唱碟更為耐用,您  
灰塵或刮持碟片時持其邊緣或中心孔和  
邊緣。  
仍需注意進行正確拿放和保存。碟片不用時,  
應放回碟片盒中豎立放避免將碟片置於  
過冷,過濕或過熱的環境陽光直射  
的環境。  
受損或弄髒的碟片會影響播放性樣應注  
意不要刮傷碟片的標籤然此面不如錄製  
面易受損,但是刮痕仍可能導致碟片無法使  
用。  
請勿在碟片上粘貼紙張或粘貼對其使用  
圓珠筆或其他帶有尖端的書寫工具。否  
則會損壞碟片。  
如果碟片沾上指灰塵等使用柔軟的乾布  
清潔,如下圖所示由中心向外緣輕輕擦拭碟  
片。  
有關碟片保養的更多信息,請參見碟片說明。  
請勿在播放機中同時裝入多張碟片。  
不可使用的碟片  
碟片在播放機內將進行高速旋果您發現  
按直線軌跡從碟片中心開始輕輕地擦拭。  
勿沿圓周軌跡旋轉擦拭碟片表面。  
碟片破裂,破曲翹或受到其他損壞,請勿  
冒險在本機內使用,否則會損壞本機。  
如有必要,用蘸取酒精的布或市售的 CD/DVD  
清潔工具徹底清潔碟切勿使用苯釋劑  
或其他清潔括設計用於清潔乙烯唱碟的  
產品。  
本機僅適合使用常規的圓形碟勿在本機  
中使用異形碟於因使用異形碟片而導致  
的任何後果,先鋒公司不承擔任何責任。  
79  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
清潔拾取頭  
本系統正確安裝和維護  
DVD放機的拾取頭在正常使用情況下應不會  
是如果出於某些原因因灰塵或髒污而  
出現故障,應咨詢鄰近的先鋒授權服務中心。  
雖然市面上售有拾取頭清潔是我們建議  
不要使用這類產為有些清潔劑可能會損  
壞拾取頭。  
安裝提示  
我們衷心希望本機能長久地為您服以當  
您選擇合適的安裝位置時請務必遵循以下幾  
 
請務必⋯  
在通風良好的房間內使用。  
關於結露問題  
如果將播放機從室外搬入溫暖的房者房  
放置在堅整的水平表面桌子,  
擱架或立體聲機架上。  
間溫度升高太快,播放機內部可能會有結露。  
雖然結露不會損壞播放會暫時影響播放  
機的性鑒於這一原因將播放機在溫暖  
溫度下放置一小時左右,然後再開機使用。  
請勿⋯  
放置在高溫或高濕場所,包括散熱器或其  
他發熱器具附近。  
放置在窗臺或其他使播放機受到陽光直射  
的地方。  
搬移本機  
如果您需要搬移本機,請先按前面板上的  
在多塵或潮濕環境中使用。  
播放機關等至  
STANDBY/ON  
Good  
從顯示幕上消失後再拔下電源勿在  
直接放置在放大器或立體聲系統中的其他  
在使用時會發熱的設備的頂部。  
Bye  
播放時提起或搬移本因為此時片將以  
高速旋轉,可能會受到損壞。  
放置在電視機或顯視器(尤其是使用室內  
天線的電視機)附近,否則可能會產生干  
擾。  
放置在廚房或其他會使播放機置身於煙霧  
或蒸汽的場所。  
Good Bye  
消失之前請勿關閉本機,否  
則本系統會返回至出廠設置。  
放置在厚重的地毯或墊子上,或者用布匹  
將本機覆蓋住。因為這樣,會妨礙本機散  
熱。  
放置在不平穩的表面或者面積不足以支撐  
四個機腳的表面上。  
80  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
電源線注意事項  
請手持插頭部分插拔電源插頭時請勿拉  
扯電當您雙手潮濕時切勿觸碰電源線否  
則可能會引起短路或電請勿將本機,家具  
或其他物體放置在電源線上,或者緊壓電源  
切勿使電源線打結者與其他電線扎在  
電源線的布線應使其無法被踩損壞  
的電源線會引起火災或電擊事故。  
請定期檢查電源如果您發現電源線受,  
請就近聯繫先鋒授權服務中心或經銷商予以  
更換。  
81  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
故障排除  
不正確的操作通常會引起故障和失靈。如果您認為該設備出了問題,請檢查以下內容。有時候  
故障可能位於另一設備中。請檢查其它所使用的設備和電器。即使執行了如下所列的檢查,仍  
不能解決故障,請聯繫附近的先鋒授權服務中心或者您的經銷商以進行修理工作。  
如果由於靜電等外部影響而使系統無法正常工作,請將電源插頭從插座處斷開,並再次插  
入返回正常工作狀態。  
一般  
問題  
措施  
電源無法開啟。  
將電源插頭連接至電源插座。  
將電源插頭從插座上斷開,並再次插入。  
請確保揚聲器電線中沒有鬆動的線頭與後面板接觸則可能導致系統自  
動關閉。  
當選如果您使用了線路輸入,請確保設備的正確連請參見72連接  
沒有聲音輸出。  
輔助設備。  
請按遙控器上的 MUTE 以關閉靜音。  
調節 VOLUME (音量。  
播放碟片時沒像輸 請確保電視機的正確連接 (請參見安裝指南。  
出。  
請將視頻輸出復位至隔行掃描 〔請參見64Component Out分量  
輸出〕  
沒有聲音從環揚聲 請參59設置聲道等級”以檢查揚聲器等級。  
器或中置揚聲傳  
出。  
請檢查您是否選擇了  
收聽。  
聲音模式(請參見30用環繞聲進行  
STEREO  
請檢查是否開啟了虛擬模請參見32使用高級環繞聲效果。  
請正確連接各揚聲器 (請參見安裝指南。  
無法操作遙控器。  
請更換電池 (請參見安裝指南。  
730°的範圍內對前面板上的遙控器感應窗進行操作(請參見安裝  
指南。  
請移去所有障礙物或換個位置進行操作。  
請避免將前面板上的遙控器感應窗暴露在直射光下。  
沒有顯示  
請確保所有設備均連接正確。  
82  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
問題  
措施  
定時器指示器閃且 請斷開本機電源,然後再接通。等待一分鐘後開啟。  
系統無法開啟。  
請確保本機 AMP分的風扇沒有被堵住。  
請檢查揚聲器已正確連接。  
如果問題仍然存把它帶至附近的先鋒授權服務中心或者您的經銷商  
處進行修理。  
DVD/CD/VCD  
播放機  
問題  
措施  
碟片在裝入後自請清潔碟片。  
出。  
請將碟片正確對準碟片導軌。  
DVD 影碟的區域編號和播放機不匹配,碟片將無法使用 (請參見第  
78DVD碟區域。  
一段使播放部的結發。請避空調附使用播放  
機。  
無法進行播放。  
如果碟片裝反,請將標籤面朝上重新裝入碟片。  
圖像播放停止,且按 (停止然後按 (播放)開始重新播放。  
ꢀ  
使用操作按鈕。  
請關閉電源一後再次使用前面板上的  
啟。  
按鈕進行開  
STANDBY/ON  
設置被取消。  
因停電或電源線被拔出而使電源被切斷,設置將被取消。  
沒有圖像/沒有顏色。 請檢查各項連接是否正確,插頭是否完全插入。  
設置。  
電視機視器的手冊以電視機視器進正確的  
如果您的電視機/監視器使S視頻電纜進行連請嘗試改變S視頻輸  
出設請參見65S-Video OutS頻輸出。  
TV Screen  
設置不正請設置電視機屏幕選項以匹配您所使用  
畫面被拉長或縱橫未  
改變。  
TV幕  
的電視機/監視請參見63TV ScreenTV。  
VCR錄音或經過 本系統採用防拷貝技在連接VCRAV擇器時防止錄音或者引起  
AV擇器圖像播  
放中存在干擾。  
圖像問題。這並非故障。  
83  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
問題  
措施  
在播放期間圖到干 播放機與 Macro-Vision統的防拷貝兼些碟片含有防拷貝信,當  
擾或者變暗。  
播放這類碟,可能會看到圖一些部分上出現等情況,這取決  
於電視機的情況。而並非故障。  
碟片對特殊播放機功能有不同的反應。當執行該功能能導致畫面短  
時間變黑或抖動。這些問題主因於碟片之間碟片內容之間的  
差異,並非播放機的故障。  
DVDCD量出現顯著 DVD CD使用不同的錄製方法。這並非故障。  
差異。  
DVD碟時,耳機 某些多聲道 DVD碟通過耳機僅輸出前置/右置聲道。  
輸出的聲音不完整。  
MP3/JPEG  
碟片  
問題  
措施  
本系統無法識CD-ROM保使用以 ISO 9660片格式錄製CD-ROM關其它碟片兼容性的資  
片。  
訊,請參見9頁一般碟片兼容。  
文件在碟片導圖片 碟片上的文件必須以正確的文件擴展名命名︰ MP3.mp3JPEG件  
瀏覽器中不顯示。  
.jpg大小寫均可關其他碟片兼容性的資請參見9一  
般碟片兼容性。  
Off  
以能訪MP3。  
JPEG件顯示,但 MP3 將初始設定選單中的圖片瀏覽器選單選項設置為  
文件不顯示。  
請參見71PhotoViewer (圖片瀏覽器。  
84  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
調諧器  
問題  
措施  
無線電廣播有大正確連接天線 (請參見安裝指南。  
音。  
請完全伸展 FM線天線,置於最佳接收位置並固定在牆上。  
請連接一根外接 FM請參見72連接外接天線。  
請調節方向與位置以獲得最佳接收。  
請連接一根附加的室內或外接 AM請參見安裝指南72連接  
外接天線。  
請關閉任何其它可能導致噪音的設備或者將它遠離主機放置。  
調諧間隔不符合您所在國家或地區。請試著切換調諧間隔 (請參見76  
改變頻率等級。  
自動調諧無法搜索無線電信號較弱動調諧將僅偵測到信號良好的廣播電臺果要獲得  
些電臺。  
靈敏度高的調諧效果,請連接一根室外天線。  
聲音只有單聲道效果。 請檢查調諧器是否設置為 FM聲道(請參見第 28改善不良FM接  
。  
錯誤訊息  
訊息  
說明  
Child Lock  
當童鎖功能開啟時,如果按下了前面板的按鈕出現該訊息。有關開啟/  
關閉兒童鎖定的詳細說明,請參見76童鎖”  
Rec Mode On  
由於錄音模式的開啟而禁止某一操作時訊息快速閃爍 2請參見第  
74錄音模式。  
Phones In  
由於連接有耳機而禁止某一操作時,該訊息快速閃爍 2。  
96K Stereo  
由於播放源為數88.296kHz PCM禁止某一操作訊息快速閃爍  
2。  
No Surr. SP  
Muting  
由於沒有環繞聲揚聲器輸出而禁止某一操作時,該訊息快速閃爍 2。  
由於聲音被靜音而禁止某一操作訊息快速閃2請參見36頁  
靜音。  
Exit  
在短暫間歇之後某一選單自動退出時,簡短出現該訊息。  
85  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
訊息  
說明  
DVD-AUDIO  
裝入 DVD碟後,當以下某個按鈕按下時該訊息快速閃爍。  
‧AUTO ‧SURROUND ‧ADVANCED ‧DIALOGUE ‧VIRTUAL SB  
‧BASS MODE  
SACD  
裝入 SACD碟後,當以下某個按鈕按下時該訊息快速閃爍。  
‧AUTO ‧SURROUND ‧ADVANCED ‧DIALOGUE ‧VIRTUAL SB  
‧BASS MODE  
86  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
設為  
4:3  
請注些電影縱橫  
屏幕尺寸和碟  
片格式  
使用語言代碼  
比大於 16:9,所以即 (  
時,寬  
Pan&Scan  
列表選擇語言  
某些語言選參  
65Language  
settings語 言 設  
〕可讓您能夠從  
88 頁“語言代碼列  
中任136語言  
為您首選的語  
言。  
使您的電視機是寬屏 屏碟片會削去畫面的  
片仍以信箱格式 兩然圖像看起來  
屏幕的頂部和 大您所看到的並  
DVD影碟可適用於幾種  
不同的屏幕縱橫從  
電視節一般4:3  
格式CinemaScope  
系統的寬屏電縱  
橫比最高7:3。  
底部顯示有黑條。  
不是整個畫面。  
標準電視機用戶  
如果您的電視機是標  
準型,本播放機的  
電視機也可使用不同  
的縱橫4:3和  
16:9。  
TV  
63設  
Screen  
置可按照您的喜好設  
1
選定 “Other  
請注多寬屏碟片  
會忽略播放機的設,  
以至無論設定為,均  
以信箱格式顯示。  
Language他語  
。  
定為  
4:3 Letter  
寬屏電視機用戶  
如果您的電視機是寬  
屏型,本播放機的  
或  
Box  
4:3  
。  
Pan&Scan  
(左/右  
ꢂ/ꢃ  
光 標)選擇是使 用代  
2
TV  
63)設  
設為  
4:3 Letter  
寬屏碟片會  
Screen  
置應設定為  
碼字母還是代碼數。  
Box  
16:9  
在屏幕的頂部和底部  
顯示黑條。  
。  
(上/下  
ꢀ/ꢁ  
光 標)選擇代碼 字母  
Wide  
3
將標4:3視機  
設為  
當您觀看以4:3格式錄  
製的碟片可以使  
用電視機控制按鈕來  
選定畫面的顯示方。  
您的電視機可以提供  
不同的縮放和拉伸選  
項;情請參見電視機  
附帶的說明書。  
16:9  
,或將寬  
或代碼數字。  
Wide  
屏電任  
何一種 格式,  
言和代碼的完  
整列表,請參見第 88  
語言代碼列表。  
4:3  
都會失  
真。  
87  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
語言代碼列表  
語言代碼字母語言代碼  
Japanese (ja), 1001  
English (en), 0514  
French (fr), 0618  
German (de), 0405  
Italian (it), 0920  
Spanish (es), 0519  
Dutch (nl), 1412  
Russian (ru), 1821  
Chinese (zh), 2608  
Korean (ko), 1115  
Greek (el), 0512  
Basque (eu), 0521  
Persian (fa), 0601  
Finnish (fi), 0609  
Fiji (fj), 0610  
Faroese (fo), 0615  
Frisian (fy), 0625  
Lithuanian (lt), 1220  
Latvian (lv), 1222  
Malagasy (mg), 1307  
Maori (mi), 1309  
Macedonian (mk), 1311  
Malayalam (ml), 1312  
Mongolian (mn), 1314  
Moldavian (mo), 1315  
Marathi (mr), 1318  
Malay (ms), 1319  
Maltese (mt), 1320  
Burmese (my), 1325  
Nauru (na), 1401  
Samoan (sm), 1913  
Shona (sn), 1914  
Somali (so), 1915  
Albanian (sq), 1917  
Serbian (sr), 1918  
Siswati (ss), 1919  
Sesotho (st), 1920  
Sundanese (su), 1921  
Swedish (sv), 1922  
Swahili (sw), 1923  
Tamil (ta), 2001  
Telugu (te), 2005  
Tajik (tg), 2007  
Thai (th), 2008  
Tigrinya (ti), 2009  
Turkmen (tk), 2011  
Tagalog (tl), 2012  
Setswana (tn), 2014  
Tonga (to), 2015  
Turkish (tr), 2018  
Irish (ga), 0701  
Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704  
Galician (gl), 0712  
Guarani (gn), 0714  
Gujarati (gu), 0721  
Hausa (ha), 0801  
Hindi (hi), 0809  
Croatian (hr), 0818  
Hungarian (hu), 0821  
Armenian (hy), 0825  
Interlingua (ia), 0901  
Interlingue (ie), 0905  
Inupiak (ik), 0911  
Indonesian (in), 0914  
Icelandic (is), 0919  
Hebrew (iw), 0923  
Yiddish (ji), 1009  
Javanese (jw), 1023  
Georgian (ka), 1101  
Kazakh (kk), 1111  
Greenlandic (kl), 1112  
Cambodian (km), 1113  
Kannada (kn), 1114  
Kashmiri (ks), 1119  
Kurdish (ku), 1121  
Kirghiz (ky), 1125  
Latin (la), 1201  
Afar (aa), 0101  
Abkhazian (ab), 0102  
Afrikaans (af), 0106  
Amharic (am), 0113  
Arabic (ar), 0118  
Assamese (as), 0119  
Aymara (ay), 0125  
Azerbaijani (az), 0126  
Bashkir (ba), 0201  
Byelorussian (be), 0205  
Bulgarian (bg), 0207  
Bihari (bh), 0208  
Bislama (bi), 0209  
Bengali (bn), 0214  
Tibetan (bo), 0215  
Breton (br), 0218  
Catalan (ca), 0301  
Corsican (co), 0315  
Czech (cs), 0319  
Nepali (ne), 1405  
Norwegian (no), 1415  
Occitan (oc), 1503  
Oromo (om), 1513  
Oriya (or), 1518  
Panjabi (pa), 1601  
Polish (pl), 1612  
Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619 Tsonga (ts), 2019  
Portuguese (pt), 1620  
Quechua (qu), 1721  
Rhaeto-Romance (rm),  
1813  
Kirundi (rn), 1814  
Romanian (ro), 1815  
Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823  
Sanskrit (sa), 1901  
Sindhi (sd), 1904  
Sangho (sg), 1907  
Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908  
Sinhalese (si), 1909  
Slovak (sk), 1911  
Tatar (tt), 2020  
Twi (tw), 2023  
Ukrainian (uk), 2111  
Urdu (ur), 2118  
Uzbek (uz), 2126  
Vietnamese (vi), 2209  
Volap?k (vo), 2215  
Wolof (wo), 2315  
Xhosa (xh), 2408  
Yoruba (yo), 2515  
Zulu (zu), 2621  
Welsh (cy), 0325  
Danish (da), 0401  
Bhutani (dz), 0426  
Esperanto (eo), 0515  
Estonian (et), 0520  
Lingala (ln), 1214  
Laothian (lo), 1215  
Slovenian (sl), 1912  
國家 ( 地區 ) 代碼列表  
()國家 ( 地區 ) 代碼國家 ( 地區 ) 代碼字母  
0118 ar  
0609 fi  
1325 my  
1907 sg  
阿根,  
,  
奧地,  
,
,  
,  
,  
,  
,
馬來西,  
墨西,  
,  
,
新加,  
西班,  
0519 es  
,  
,
,
,
,
,
0121 au  
0618 fr  
1324 mx  
,
,
,
,
0120 at  
0205 be  
0405 de  
0811 hk  
1412 nl  
1905 se  
0308 ch  
1426 nz  
比利,  
,
,
紐西,  
,
,  
,
西, 0218, br  
, 0914, in  
, 1415, no  
巴基斯,  
, 2023, tw  
加拿,  
,
印度尼西,  
,
,
,  
,
0301 ca  
0904 id  
1611 pk  
2008 th  
0312 cl  
0920 it  
1608 ph  
0702 gb  
, 2119, us  
,  
,
義大,  
,
菲律,  
葡萄, 1620, pt  
俄羅斯聯, ,  
,
,  
,
, 0314, cn  
,  
, 1016, jp  
,  
,
,
0411 dk  
1118 kr  
1821 ru  
88  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
預設代碼列表  
請注意,可能在分配了正確的預設代碼後只能控制部分功能,也有可能列表中的製造商代碼對  
您使用的機型無效。  
製造商 代碼  
ACURA 644  
ADMIRAL 631  
AIWA 660  
AKAI 632, 635, 642  
AKURA 641  
ALBA 607, 639, 641, 644  
AMSTRAD 642, 644, 647  
ANITECH 644  
ASA 645  
FERGUSON 607, 636, 651  
FINLANDIA 635, 643, 655  
FINLUX 632, 607, 645, 648, KAISUI 618, 641, 644  
653, 654, 655  
JEC 605  
JVC 613, 623  
PALLADIUM 638  
PANAMA 646  
PANASONIC 631, 607,  
608,642, 622  
PATHO CINEMA 642  
PAUSA 644  
PHILCO 632, 642  
PHILIPS 631, 607, 634, 656  
PHOENIX 632  
KAPSCH 631  
KENDO 642  
KENNEDY 632, 642  
KORPEL 607  
FIRSTLINE 640, 644  
FISHER 632, 635, 638, 645  
FORMENTI 632, 607, 642  
FRONTECH 631, 642, 646  
KOYODA 644  
FRONTECH/PROTECH 632 LEYCO 607, 640, 646, 648  
ASUKA 641  
FUJITSU 648, 629  
FUNAI 640, 646, 658  
GBC 632, 642  
GE 601, 608, 607, 610, 617, M-ELECTRONIC 631, 644,  
602, 628, 618  
GEC 607, 634, 648  
GELOSO 632, 644  
GENEXXA 631, 641  
GOLDSTAR 610, 623, 621, MAGNAVOX 607, 610,  
602, 607, 650  
LIESENK&TTER 607  
LOEWE 607  
LUXOR 632, 642, 643  
PHONOLA 607  
AUDIOGONIC 607, 636  
BASIC LINE 641, 644  
BAUR 631, 607, 642  
BEKO 638  
PROFEX 642, 644  
PROTECH 607, 642, 644,  
646, 649  
QUELLE631, 632, 607, 642,  
645, 653  
R-LINE 607  
RADIOLA 607  
645, 654, 655, 656, 607,  
636, 651  
MAGNADYNE 632, 649  
MAGNAFON 649  
BEON 607  
BLAUPUNKT 631  
BLUE SKY 641  
BLUE STAR 618  
BPL 618  
RADIOSHACK 610, 623,  
621, 602  
603, 612, 629  
BRANDT 636  
BTC 641  
BUSH 607, 641, 642, 644,  
647, 656  
CASCADE 644  
CATHAY 607  
CENTURION 607  
CGB 642  
GOODMANS 607, 639,  
647, 648, 656  
GORENJE 638  
MANESTH 639, 646  
MARANTZ 607  
MARK 607  
MATSUI 607, 639, 640,  
642, 644, 647, 648  
MCMICHAEL 634  
MEDIATOR 607  
MEMOREX 644  
METZ 631  
MINERVA 631, 653  
MITSUBISHI 609, 610, 602, SAMSUNG 607, 638, 644,  
621, 631  
MULTITECH 644, 649  
NEC 659  
RBM 653  
RCA 601, 610, 615, 616,  
617, 618, 661, 662, 609  
REDIFFUSION 632, 642  
REX 631, 646  
ROADSTAR 641, 644, 646  
SABA 631, 636, 642, 651  
SAISHO 639, 644, 646  
SALORA 631, 632, 642, 643  
SAMBERS 649  
GPM 641  
GRAETZ 631, 642  
GRANADA 607, 635, 642,  
643, 648  
GRADIENTE 630, 657  
GRANDIN 618  
GRUNDIG 631, 653  
HANSEATIC 607, 642  
HCM 618, 644  
HINARI 607, 641, 644  
HISAWA 618  
HITACHI 631, 633, 634,  
636, 642, 643, 654, 606,  
610, 624, 625, 618  
HUANYU 656  
HYPSON 607, 618, 646  
ICE 646, 647  
IMPERIAL 638, 642  
INDIANA 607  
INGELEN 631  
CIMLINE 644  
CLARIVOX 607  
CLATRONIC 638  
CONDOR 638  
CONTEC 644  
CROSLEY 632  
CROWN 638, 644  
CRYSTAL 642  
CYBERTRON 641  
DAEWOO 607, 644, 656  
DAINICHI 641  
DANSAI 607  
DAYTON 644  
DECCA 607, 648  
DIXI 607, 644  
DUMONT 653  
ELIN 607  
646  
SANYO 635, 645, 648, 621,  
614  
SBR 607, 634  
NECKERMANN 631, 607  
NEI 607, 642  
NIKKAI 605, 607, 641, 646, SCHNEIDER 607, 641, 647  
SCHAUB LORENZ 642  
648  
SEG 642, 646  
NOBLIKO 649  
SEI 632, 640, 649  
SELECO 631, 642  
SHARP 602, 619, 627  
SIAREM 632, 649  
SIEMENS 631  
SINUDYNE 632, 639, 640,  
649  
NOKIA 632, 642, 652  
NORDMENDE 632, 636,  
651, 652  
OCEANIC 631, 632, 642  
INTERFUNK 631, 632, 607, ORION 632, 607, 639, 640  
642  
INTERVISION 646, 649  
ISUKAI 641  
ITC 642  
OSAKI 641, 646, 648  
OSO 641  
OSUME 648  
OTTO VERSAND 631, 632, SONOKO 607, 644  
607, 642 SONOLOR 631, 635  
ELITE 641  
ELTA 644  
EMERSON 642  
ERRES 607  
SKANTIC 643  
SOLAVOX 631  
ITT 631, 632, 642  
89  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
SONTEC 607  
SONY 604  
SOUNDWAVE 607  
STANDARD 641, 644  
STERN 631  
SUSUMU 641  
SYSLINE 607  
TANDY 631, 641, 648  
TASHIKO 634  
TATUNG 607, 648  
TEC 642  
TELEAVIA 636  
TELEFUNKEN 636, 637, 652  
TELETECH 644  
TENSAI 640, 641  
THOMSON 636, 651, 652, 663  
THORN 631, 607, 642, 645, 648  
TOMASHI 618  
TOSHIBA 605, 602, 626, 621, 653  
TOWADA 642  
ULTRAVOX 632, 642, 649  
UNIVERSUM 631, 607, 638, 642, 645, 646, 654, 655  
VESTEL 607  
VICTOR 613  
VOXSON 631  
WALTHAM 643  
WATSON 607  
WATT RADIO 632, 642, 649  
WHITE  
WESTINGHOUSE 607  
YOKO 607, 642, 646  
ZENITH 603, 620  
PIONEER 600, 631, 632, 607, 636, 642, 651  
90  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
杜比數位  
術語  
1
模擬音頻  
直接表現聲音的電信與可以為電信號但  
對聲音間接表現的數位音頻相比較。可參見  
數位音頻。  
採用最多5.1道的音頻種高質量的環  
繞聲系統被應用於世界上許多高級電影院中。  
螢幕顯示可表明哪一個聲道正在使用如  
顯示 3/2.1,3 為兩個前聲道和中央聲道;  
2環繞聲聲道,1LFE道。  
縱橫比  
電視屏幕寬度相對高度的統電視縱橫比  
4:3換言之,屏幕接近於正方形寬屏  
電視機16:9(屏幕的寬幾乎是高的兩倍。  
杜比專業邏輯/專業邏輯  
II  
DVD  
附送類 (僅用於  
唱碟)  
某些 DVD 唱碟具附送”類,該類需要密  
碼才能獲取。請參見第 69 Bonus Group  
(附送類。  
矩陣解碼系統可2聲道播放源中提4.1  
(杜比專業)或者 5.1比專業邏輯  
II)聲道環繞聲。  
DVD  
可瀏覽圖片 (僅用於  
唱碟)  
DTS  
DVD碟具有該功能使用戶在播放音頻  
時可瀏覽錄製在碟片上的靜像。請參圖  
片放映。  
R
DTSDigital Theater System數位影院  
系統DTS 是一種不同於杜比數位的環繞聲  
系統,它已經成為電影中較普及的環繞聲格  
式。  
數位音頻  
通過數字對聲音間接表錄製過程中,聲音  
通過模數轉換器以離散的間隔進行測CD  
音頻為每秒 44,100 次生成數字流。播放  
時,數模轉換器再根據這些數字生成模擬信  
號。可參取樣頻率模擬音頻。  
動態範圍  
音頻信號中最響聲音和最輕聲音之間的差值  
(沒有失真或沒有在噪聲中損失數位  
DTS道都有很寬的動態範圍夠產生影  
院級的動態效果。  
91  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
EXIF  
MPEG  
視頻  
(可交換圖像文件)  
這是Fuji Photo Film發的一種用於數位  
相機的文件格多廠商生產的數位相機都  
使用這種壓縮的文件格式帶有日期,時間  
和縮略圖資訊以及圖片數據。  
VCDDVD片的一種視頻格式。VCD採  
用較早的 MPEG-1準,DVD用更新,質  
量更好MPEG-2準。  
PBC  
(播放控制僅用於  
VCD/  
VCD  
超級 )  
通過錄製在碟片上的螢幕顯示選單瀏覽 VCD/  
VCD一種系其適用於不是一次從  
頭看到尾的碟片,例如卡OK片。  
文件擴展名  
加在文件末尾的標籤,表示文件的類型。例  
.mp3”表MP3件。  
ISO 9660  
格式  
CD-ROM片容量和文件結構的國際標準。  
PCM  
(脈碼調制)  
CD 和 DAT 上最常見的數位音頻編碼系統。質  
量絕佳,但是與杜比數位和 MPEG 音頻等格式  
要大量的數數位音頻 。  
JPEG  
如照片和插圖)的文件格式。JPEG 文  
.jpg”.JPG”擴展名識別。絕大  
部分的數位相機都採用這種格式。  
DVD  
區域 (僅用於  
影碟)  
將碟片和播放機與世界上的特定區域聯繫在  
一起。本機僅播放具有兼容區域代碼的碟片。  
您可以在後面板上看到本機的區域代的  
碟片與不止一個的區域兼或與所有區域  
兼容。  
MP3  
MP3MPEG1 音頻層 3)是一種壓縮的音頻文  
件格式。文件以 “.mp3”.MP3”擴展名  
識別。  
S1 S  
視頻輸出  
該S視頻信號格式在視頻信號中包含縱橫比資  
MLP  
這是一種無損的壓縮格使DVD碟中保  
PCM  
DVD  
(僅用於 唱碟)  
/壓縮  
4:316:9。  
PCM頻比其他方式所保存的多。  
S2 S  
視頻輸出  
S2S 頻的增強版除了縱橫比資訊外,  
還包letterbox/pan & scan訊。與 S2 S  
視頻兼容的寬屏電視機可根據信號自動切換  
至合適的模式。  
MPEG  
音頻  
VCDDVD片的一種音頻格。本  
機可以MPEG 音頻轉換PCM式,以更好  
地與數位錄製設備AV大器兼容。可參見  
PCM脈碼調制。  
92  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
取樣頻率  
轉換成數位音頻數據時聲音的測量頻率  
越高,音質越好,但是將生成更多的數位資  
訊。標準 CD 音頻的取樣頻率為 44.1kHz,即  
指每秒取測量)44,100。可參數  
位音頻。  
DVD VCD/  
圖片放映 (  
VCD  
超級  
DVD 碟片VCD/ 超級 VCD有該功能,  
可使錄製在碟片上的靜像在播放音頻時自動  
循環播放。請參“可瀏覽圖片。  
SACD  
超級音頻 (  
超級音頻 CD 是一種高質量的音頻碟片格式,  
可在同一張碟片上容納高取樣頻率立體聲和  
多聲道音頻,以及常CD頻。  
93  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
重量︰  
DVD/CD調諧器 ......................3.2 kg  
顯示.............................0.2 kg  
規格  
放大器部分  
連續功RMS)................ 75W聲道  
...................(1 kHz, THD 10%, 6 )  
附件  
操作說明..............................1  
設置................................1  
顯示..................................1  
遙控..................................1  
電源..................................1  
視頻電黃色插頭....................1  
顯示幕電灰色插頭..................1  
控制電A色插頭..................1  
控制電B色插頭..................1  
FM線 .................................1  
AM形天線 .............................1  
乾電AA/R6).........................2  
揚聲器電5 米......................3  
揚聲器電10 米.....................2  
防滑中置揚聲器)  
(僅S-DV700ST) ....................3  
防滑超低音揚聲器..................4  
揚聲器支前置/環繞聲揚聲器........4  
揚聲器支中置揚聲器)  
(僅S-DV900ST) ....................1  
大螺僅限 S-DV900ST................8  
中螺僅限 S-DV900ST................2  
小螺僅限 S-DV900ST...............16  
僅限 S-DV900ST..................4  
碟片部分  
數位音頻  
..............DVD fs: 96 kHz, 24元  
......DVD 系統,VCD 系統和 CD 數位音頻  
系統  
頻率響應  
48 kHz................4 Hz-22 kHz  
96 kHz................4 Hz-44 kHz  
192 kHz...............4 Hz-88 kHz  
信噪.............................108 dB  
動態範............................95 dB  
總諧波失........................0.005 %  
抖晃...........................量限制  
±0.001 % W.PEAK)或以下 (JEITA)  
FM  
調諧器部分  
頻率範......................87.5-108MHz  
........................ 75 ,非平衡  
AM  
頻率範圍  
調諧器部分  
....531 kHz1,602 kHz使用 9 kHz級)  
...530 kHz1,700 kHz使用 10 kHz級)  
.............................形天線  
衛星揚聲器系統 (  
封閉型防磁式  
S-DV700ST  
揚聲.....................8.7 cm錐型)  
...........................5.2 cm錐型)  
其他  
電源要求  
額定阻............................. 6  
...AC 110-120 V/220-230 V/240 V,50/60 Hz  
................................172 W  
待機模式下  
頻率範.....................80-20,000 Hz  
最大輸....................75 WJEITA)  
前置/環繞聲揚聲器  
...............................0.55 W  
尺寸  
......110寬) 59深) 284高)cm  
×
×
尺寸:  
DVD/CD調諧器  
...............................0.7 kg  
中置揚聲器  
尺寸  
......284寬) 59深) 110高)cm  
×
......360寬) 74高) 270深)mm  
×
顯示.274寬) 44高) 35深)mm  
×
×
×
×
...............................0.7 kg  
94  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
S-DV900ST  
衛星揚聲器系統 (  
類型 ........................板式書架型  
揚聲器  
因產品改進,規格與設計若有變更恕不另  
行通知。  
振蕩器 ............2.5 cm 振蕩器 × 3  
高音揚聲器 ......2.6 cm (半球頂形)  
額定阻抗 ............................ 6  
本產品包NEC司授權使用的  
FontAvenue字體。FontAvenue是  
NEC司的註冊商標。  
頻率範圍 .................100 - 35,000 Hz  
最大輸入 ...................75 WJEITA)  
前置/環繞聲揚聲器  
尺寸  
..... 120寬) 30深) 450 (高)cm  
×
×
日本先鋒公司出版  
重量 .............................. 0.9 kg  
版權 2003本先鋒公司  
中置揚聲器  
尺寸  
..... 420寬) 32深) 120 (高)cm  
版權所有  
×
×
重量 .............................. 0.9 kg  
有源超低音揚聲器  
S-DV700SW/S-DV900SW)  
類型 ..............音反射地面型,防磁式  
揚聲器 .....................18 cm錐型)  
額定阻抗 ............................ 6  
頻率範圍 .....................25-2,300 Hz  
最大輸入 ...................75 WJEITA)  
尺寸  
×
.... 192寬) 436深) 395 (高)cm  
重量 ............................. 12.5 kg  
×
95  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
96  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
附加資訊  
97  
ChH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PIONEER CORPORATION  
4-1, Meguro 1-Chome, Meguro-ku, Tokyo 153-8654, Japan  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC.  
P.O. BOX 1540, Long Beach, California 90810-1540, U.S.A. TEL: (800) 421-1404  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS OF CANADA, INC.  
300 Allstate Parkway, Markham, Ontario L3R OP2, Canada TEL: (905) 479-4411  
PIONEER EUROPE NV  
Haven 1087, Keetberglaan 1, B-9120 Melsele, Belgium TEL: 03/570.05.11  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS ASIACENTRE PTE. LTD.  
253 Alexandra Road, #04-01, Singapore 159936 TEL: 656-472-1111  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS AUSTRALIA PTY. LTD.  
178-184 Boundary Road, Braeside, Victoria 3195, Australia, TEL: (03) 9586-6300  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS DE MEXICO S.A. DE C.V.  
Blvd.Manuel Avila Camacho 138 10 piso Col.Lomas de Chapultepec, Mexico,D.F. 11000 TEL: 55-9178-4270  
<TWKCW/03G00001>  
Printed in  
<ARC7496-A>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Peavey Car Speaker PR 15P User Manual
Philips DVD Recorder DVDR 725H 00 User Manual
Philips MP3 Player AE2180 User Manual
Philips Network Card Network Adaper User Manual
Philips Switch SWV1010 User Manual
Philips Universal Remote SRU4040 User Manual
Pitco Frialator Outboard Motor L22 376 User Manual
Plantronics Bluetooth Headset M 3000 User Manual
Polycom Cordless Telephone IP 3000 User Manual
PYLE Audio CD Player PICL82 User Manual